Publication Number S71PL254/127/064/032J_00 Revision A Amendment 4 Issue Date July 16, 2004
ADVANCE
S71PL254/127/064/032J based MCPs
Stacked Multi-Chip Product (MCP) Flash Memory and RAM
256M/128/64/32 Megabit (16/8/4/2M x 16-bit) CMOS 3.0 Volt-only
Simultaneous Operation Page Mode Flash Memory and
64/32/16/8/4 Megabit (4M/2M/1M/512K/256K x 16-bit) Static
RAM/Pseudo Static RAM
Distinctive Characteristics
MCP Features
Power supply voltage of 2.7 to 3.1 volt
High performance
—55 ns
65 ns (65 ns Flash, 70ns pSRAM)
Packages
7 x 9 x 1.2mm 56 ball FBGA
8 x 11.6 x 1.2mm 64 ball FBGA
8 x 11.6 x 1.4mm 84 ball FBGA
Operating Temperature
–25°C to +85°C
–40°C to +85°C
General Description
The S71PL series is a product line of stacked Multi-Chip Product (MCP) packages
and consists of:
One or more S29PL (Simultaneous Read/Write) Flash memory die
pSRAM or SRAM
The 256Mb Flash memory consists of two S29PL127J devices. In this case, CE#f2
is used to access the second Flash and no extra address lines are required.
The products covered by this document are listed in the table below:
Note: Not recommended for new designs; use pSRAM based MCPs instead.
Flash Memory Density
32Mb 64Mb 128Mb 256Mb
pSRAM
Density
4Mb S71PL032J40
8Mb S71PL032J80 S71PL064J80
16Mb S71PL032JA0 S71PL064JA0 S71PL127JA0
32Mb S71PL064JB0 S71PL127JB0 S71PL254JB0
64Mb S71PL127JC0 S71PL254JC0
Flash Memory Density
32Mb 64Mb
SRAM Density (Note)
4Mb S71PL032J04
8Mb S71PL032J08 S71PL064J08
2 S71PL254/127/064/032J based MCPs S71PL254/127/064/032J_00_A4 July 16, 2004
Preliminary
Product Selector Guide
32Mb Flash Memory
64Mb Flash Memory
128Mb Flash Memory
Device-Model# Flash Access time (ns) (p)SRAM density (p)SRAM Access time (ns) pSRAM type Package
S71PL032J04-0B 65 4M SRAM 70 SRAM2 TLC056
S71PL032J04-0F 65 4M SRAM 70 SRAM3 TLC056
S71PL032J08-0B 65 8M SRAM 70 SRAM2 TLC056
S71PL032J40-07 65 4M pSRAM 70 pSRAM1 TLC056
S71PL032J80-05 55 8M pSRAM 55 pSRAM1 TLC056
S71PL032J80-07 65 8M pSRAM 70 pSRAM1 TLC056
S71PL032JA0-0K 65 16Mb pSRAM 70 pSRAM1 TLC056
S71PL032JA0-0F 65 16Mb pSRAM 70 pSRAM3 TLC056
Device-Model# Flash Access time (ns) (p)SRAM density (p)SRAM Access time (ns) (p)SRAM type Package
S71PL064J08-0B 65 8M SRAM 70 SRAM2 TLC056
S71PL064J08-0U 65 8M SRAM 70 SRAM4 TLC056
S71PL064J80-0K 65 8M pSRAM 70 pSRAM1 TLC056
S71PL064JA0-05 55 8M pSRAM 55 pSRAM1 TLC056
S71PL064JA0-0K 65 16M pSRAM 70 pSRAM1 TLC056
S71PL064JA0-0P 65 16M pSRAM 70 pSRAM7 TLC056
S71PL064JB0-07 65 32M pSRAM 70 pSRAM1 TLC056
S71PL064JB0-0U 65 32M pSRAM 70 pSRAM6 TLC056
Device-Model# Flash Access time (ns) pSRAM density pSRAM Access time (ns) pSRAM type Package
S71PL127JA0-9P 65 16M pSRAM 70 pSRAM7 TLA064
S71PL127JB0-97 65 32M pSRAM 70 pSRAM1 TLA064
S71PL127JB0-9Z 65 32M pSRAM 70 pSRAM7 TLA064
S71PL127JB0-9U 65 32M pSRAM 70 pSRAM6 TLA064
S71PL127JC0-97 65 64M pSRAM 70 pSRAM1 TLA064
S71PL127JC0-9Z 65 64M pSRAM 70 pSRAM7 TLA064
S71PL127JC0-9U 65 64M pSRAM 70 pSRAM6 TLA064
July 16, 2004 S71PL254/127/064/032J_00_A4 S71PL254/127/064/032J based MCPs 3
Preliminary
256Mb Flash Memory (2xS29PL127J)
Device-Model# Flash Access time (ns) pSRAM density pSRAM Access time (ns) pSRAM type Package
S71PL254JB0-T7 65 32M pSRAM 70 pSRAM1 FTA084
S71PL254JB0-TB 65 32M pSRAM 70 pSRAM2 FTA084
S71PL254JB0-TU 65 32M pSRAM 70 pSRAM6 FTA084
S71PL254JC0-TB 65 64M pSRAM 70 pSRAM2 FTA084
S71PL254JC0-TU 65 64M pSRAM 70 pSRAM6 FTA084
S71PL254JC0-TZ 65 64M pSRAM 70 pSRAM7 FTA084
July 16, 2004 S71PL254/127/064/032J_00A3 3
Advance Information
S71PL254/127/064/032J based MCPs
Distinctive Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
MCP Features ........................................................................................................ 1
General Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Product Selector Guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2
32Mb Flash Memory .............................................................................................2
64Mb Flash Memory .............................................................................................2
128Mb Flash Memory ...........................................................................................2
Connection Diagram (S71PL032J) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8
Connection Diagram (S71PL064J) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9
Connection Diagram (S71PL127J) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
Connection Diagram (S71PL254J) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
Special Handling Instructions For FBGA Package .................................. 11
Pin Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
Logic Symbol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
Ordering Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
Physical Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
TLC056—56-ball Fine-Pitch Ball Grid Array (FBGA)
9 x 7mm Package ................................................................................................. 18
TLA064—64-ball Fine-Pitch Ball Grid Array (FBGA)
8 x 11.6mm Package ............................................................................................. 19
FTA084—84-ball Fine-Pitch Ball Grid Array (FBGA)
8 x 11.6mm ............................................................................................................ 20
S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP
General Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
Simultaneous Read/Write Operation with Zero Latency ......................23
Page Mode Features ...........................................................................................23
Standard Flash Memory Features ...................................................................23
Product Selector Guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25
Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
Simultaneous Read/Write Block Diagram . . . . . 27
Pin Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .28
Logic Symbol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Device Bus Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .29
Table 1. PL127J Device Bus Operations ................................ 29
Requirements for Reading Array Data ........................................................ 29
Random Read (Non-Page Read) ............................................................... 29
Page Mode Read ............................................................................................. 30
Table 2. Page Select .......................................................... 30
Simultaneous Read/Write Operation .......................................................... 30
Table 3. Bank Select .......................................................... 30
Writing Commands/Command Sequences ..................................................31
Accelerated Program Operation ................................................................31
Autoselect Functions ......................................................................................31
Automatic Sleep Mode ......................................................................................32
RESET#: Hardware Reset Pin .........................................................................32
Output Disable Mode ........................................................................................32
Table 4. PL127J Sector Architecture ..................................... 33
Table 5. PL064J Sector Architecture ..................................... 40
Table 6. PL032J Sector Architecture ..................................... 43
Table 7. SecSiTM Sector Addresses ...................................... 44
Autoselect Mode .................................................................................................45
Table 8. Autoselect Codes (High Voltage Method) .................. 45
Table 9. PL127J Boot Sector/Sector Block Addresses for
Protection/Unprotection ..................................................... 46
Table 10. PL064J Boot Sector/Sector Block Addresses for
Protection/Unprotection ..................................................... 47
Table 11. PL032J Boot Sector/Sector Block Addresses for
Protection/Unprotection ...................................................... 48
Selecting a Sector Protection Mode .............................................................48
Table 12. Sector Protection Schemes ................................... 49
Persistent Sector Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Persistent Protection Bit (PPB) ......................................................................49
Persistent Protection Bit Lock (PPB Lock) .................................................50
Persistent Sector Protection Mode Locking Bit ........................................ 51
Password Protection Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Password and Password Mode Locking Bit ................................................ 52
64-bit Password .................................................................................................. 52
Write Protect (WP#) ....................................................................................... 53
Persistent Protection Bit Lock ................................................................... 53
High Voltage Sector Protection ..................................................................... 53
Figure 1. In-System Sector Protection/Sector Unprotection
Algorithms........................................................................ 54
Temporary Sector Unprotect ........................................................................ 55
Figure 2. Temporary Sector Unprotect Operation ................... 55
SecSi™ (Secured Silicon) Sector Flash Memory Region .......................... 55
Factory-Locked Area (64 words) .............................................................. 55
Customer-Lockable Area (64 words) ......................................................56
SecSi Sector Protection Bits ....................................................................... 56
Figure 3. SecSi Sector Protect Verify .................................... 57
Hardware Data Protection ............................................................................. 57
Low VCC Write Inhibit ................................................................................ 57
Write Pulse “Glitch” Protection ............................................................... 57
Logical Inhibit ................................................................................................... 57
Power-Up Write Inhibit ............................................................................... 57
Common Flash Memory Interface (CFI) . . . . . . 58
Table 13. CFI Query Identification String .............................. 58
Table 14. System Interface String ........................................ 59
Table 15. Device Geometry Definition ................................... 59
Table 16. Primary Vendor-Specific Extended Query ................ 60
Command Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
Reading Array Data ...........................................................................................62
Reset Command .................................................................................................62
Autoselect Command Sequence .................................................................... 63
Enter SecSi™ Sector/Exit SecSi Sector Command Sequence ................ 63
Word Program Command Sequence ........................................................... 63
Unlock Bypass Command Sequence ........................................................64
Figure 4. Program Operation ............................................... 65
Chip Erase Command Sequence ...................................................................65
Sector Erase Command Sequence ................................................................66
Figure 5. Erase Operation ................................................... 67
Erase Suspend/Erase Resume Commands .................................................. 67
Password Program Command .......................................................................68
Password Verify Command .............................................................................68
Password Protection Mode Locking Bit Program Command ..............68
Persistent Sector Protection Mode Locking Bit Program
Command ............................................................................................................. 69
SecSi Sector Protection Bit Program Command ......................................69
PPB Lock Bit Set Command ............................................................................69
DYB Write Command ......................................................................................69
Password Unlock Command ..........................................................................69
PPB Program Command .................................................................................. 70
All PPB Erase Command ..................................................................................70
DYB Write Command ......................................................................................70
PPB Lock Bit Set Command ............................................................................70
Command .............................................................................................................. 71
Command Definitions Tables .......................................................................... 71
Table 17. Memory Array Command Definitions ...................... 71
4S71PL254/127/064/032J_00A3 July 16, 2004
Advance Information
Table 18. Sector Protection Command Definitions .................. 72
Write Operation Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
DQ7: Data# Polling ............................................................................................73
Figure 6. Data# Polling Algorithm......................................... 74
DQ6: Toggle Bit I ................................................................................................75
Figure 7. Toggle Bit Algorithm.............................................. 76
DQ2: Toggle Bit II ...............................................................................................76
Reading Toggle Bits DQ6/DQ2 ......................................................................76
DQ5: Exceeded Timing Limits ........................................................................77
DQ3: Sector Erase Timer .................................................................................77
Table 19. Write Operation Status ......................................... 78
Absolute Maximum Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .79
Figure 8. Maximum Overshoot Waveforms............................. 79
Operating Ranges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80
Industrial (I) Devices ......................................................................................... 80
Extended (E) Devices ........................................................................................80
Supply Voltages ................................................................................................... 80
DC Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Table 20. CMOS Compatible ................................................ 81
AC Characteristic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .82
Test Conditions .................................................................................................. 82
Figure 9. Test Setups......................................................... 82
Table 21. Test Specifications ............................................... 82
SWITCHING WAVEFORMS ..........................................................................83
Table 22. KEY TO SWITCHING WAVEFORMS ......................... 83
Figure 10. Input Waveforms and Measurement Levels............. 83
VCC RampRate ...................................................................................................83
Read Operations ................................................................................................ 84
Table 23. Read-Only Operations .......................................... 84
Figure 11. Read Operation Timings ....................................... 84
Figure 12. Page Read Operation Timings ............................... 85
Reset ...................................................................................................................... 85
Table 24. Hardware Reset (RESET#) .................................... 85
Figure 13. Reset Timings..................................................... 86
Erase/Program Operations ............................................................................. 87
Table 25. Erase and Program Operations .............................. 87
Timing Diagrams .................................................................................................88
Figure 14. Program Operation Timings .................................. 88
Figure 15. Accelerated Program Timing Diagram .................... 88
Figure 16. Chip/Sector Erase Operation Timings ..................... 89
Figure 17. Back-to-back Read/Write Cycle Timings ................. 89
Figure 18. Data# Polling Timings (During Embedded
Algorithms) ....................................................................... 90
Figure 19. Toggle Bit Timings (During Embedded Algorithms) .. 90
Figure 20. DQ2 vs. DQ6 ...................................................... 91
Protect/Unprotect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
Table 26. Temporary Sector Unprotect ................................. 91
Figure 21. Temporary Sector Unprotect Timing Diagram.......... 91
Figure 22. Sector/Sector Block Protect and Unprotect Timing
Diagram............................................................................ 92
Controlled Erase Operations ..........................................................................93
Table 27. Alternate CE# Controlled Erase and Program
Operations ....................................................................... 93
Table 28. Alternate CE# Controlled Write (Erase/Program)
Operation Timings ............................................................. 94
Table 29. Erase And Programming Performance .................... 95
BGA Pin Capacitance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Type 2 pSRAM
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
Product Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
Pin Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
Power Up Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
Timing Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Power Up ..............................................................................................................99
Figure 23. Power Up 1 (CS1# Controlled) ............................. 99
Figure 24. Power Up 2 (CS2 Controlled)................................ 99
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Absolute Maximum Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
DC Recommended Operating Conditions . . . . . 100
Capacitance (Ta = 25°C, f = 1 MHz) . . . . . . . . . . 100
DC and Operating Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Common ............................................................................................................. 100
16M pSRAM ...........................................................................................................101
32M pSRAM ..........................................................................................................101
64M pSRAM .........................................................................................................102
AC Operating Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Test Conditions (Test Load and Test Input/Output Reference) ........102
Figure 25. Output Load .................................................... 102
ACC Characteristics (Ta = -40°C to 85°C, V
CC
= 2.7 to 3.1 V) ........103
Timing Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
Read Timings .......................................................................................................104
Figure 26. Timing Waveform of Read Cycle(1) ..................... 104
Figure 27. Timing Waveform of Read Cycle(2) ..................... 104
Figure 28. Timing Waveform of Read Cycle(2) ..................... 104
Write Timings .....................................................................................................105
Figure 29. Write Cycle #1 (WE# Controlled)........................ 105
Figure 30. Write Cycle #2 (CS1# Controlled) ...................... 105
Figure 31. Timing Waveform of Write Cycle(3) (CS2
Controlled) ..................................................................... 106
Figure 32. Timing Waveform of Write Cycle(4) (UB#, LB#
Controlled) ..................................................................... 106
pSRAM Type 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
Pin Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
Operation Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Absolute Maximum Ratings (see Note) . . . . . . . 108
DC Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Table 30. DC Recommended Operating Conditions ............... 108
Table 31. DC Characteristics (T
A
= -25
°
C to 85
°
C, VDD
= 2.6 to 3.3V) ................................................................. 109
AC Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
Table 32. AC Characteristics and Operating Conditions
(T
A
= -25
°
C to 85
°
C, V
DD
= 2.6 to 3.3V) ............................. 109
Table 33. AC Test Conditions ............................................. 110
Figure 33. AC Test Loads .................................................. 110
Figure 34. State Diagram ................................................. 111
Table 34. Standby Mode Characteristics .............................. 111
Timing Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
Figure 35. Read Cycle 1—Addressed Controlled ................... 111
Figure 36. Read Cycle 2—CS1# Controlled.......................... 112
Figure 37. Write Cycle 1—WE# Controlled .......................... 112
Figure 38. Write Cycle 2—CS1# Controlled ......................... 113
Figure 39. Write Cycle3—UB#, LB# Controlled .................... 113
Figure 40. Deep Power-down Mode .................................... 114
Figure 41. Power-up Mode ................................................ 114
Figure 42. Abnormal Timing .............................................. 114
pSRAM Type 6
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Pin Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
July 16, 2004 S71PL254/127/064/032J_00A3 5
Advance Information
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
Absolute Maximum Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
DC Recommended Operating Conditions
(Ta = -40°C to 85°C) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
DC Characteristics (Ta = -40°C to 85°C, VDD
= 2.6 to 3.3 V) (See Note 3 to 4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
Capacitance (Ta = 25°C, f = 1 MHz) . . . . . . . . . . 117
AC Characteristics and Operating Conditions . 117
(Ta = -40°C to 85°C, VDD = 2.6 to 3.3 V) (See Note 5 to 11) ............ 117
AC Test Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Timing Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Read Timings .......................................................................................................119
Figure 43. Read Cycle ....................................................... 119
Figure 44. Page Read Cycle (8 Words Access) ...................... 120
Write Timings ..................................................................................................... 121
Figure 45. Write Cycle #1 (WE# Controlled) (See Note 8) ..... 121
Figure 46. Write Cycle #2 (CE# Controlled) (See Note 8) ...... 122
Deep Power-down Timing ............................................................................. 122
Figure 47. Deep Power Down Timing................................... 122
Power-on Timing ............................................................................................... 122
Figure 48. Power-on Timing ............................................... 122
Provisions of Address Skew ........................................................................... 123
Read .................................................................................................................. 123
Figure 49. Read ............................................................... 123
Write ................................................................................................................ 123
Figure 50. Write............................................................... 123
pSRAM Type 7
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Pin Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Power Down (for 32M, 64M Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Power Down ...................................................................................................... 126
Power Down Program Sequence ............................................................... 127
Address Key ....................................................................................................... 127
Absolute Maximum Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
Recommended Operating Conditions (See
Warning Below) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
Package Capacitance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
DC Characteristics (Under Recommended
Conditions Unless Otherwise Noted) . . . . . . . . . 129
AC Characteristics (Under Recommended
Operating Conditions Unless Otherwise
Noted) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
Read Operation ................................................................................................. 130
AC Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
Write Operation ............................................................................................... 132
AC Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
Power Down Parameters ................................................................................133
Other Timing Parameters ...............................................................................133
AC Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
AC Test Conditions ......................................................................................... 134
AC Measurement Output Load Circuit ..................................................... 134
Figure 51. AC Output Load Circuit....................................... 134
Timing Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Read Timings .......................................................................................................135
Figure 52. Read Timing #1 (Basic Timing) ........................... 135
Figure 53. Read Timing #2 (OE# Address Access ................. 135
Figure 54. Read Timing #3 (LB#/UB# Byte Access) ............. 136
Figure 55. Read Timing #4 (Page Address Access after CE1#
Control Access for 32M and 64M Only) ............................... 136
Figure 56. Read Timing #5 (Random and Page Address Access for
32M and 64M Only) ......................................................... 137
Write Timings .....................................................................................................137
Figure 57. Write Timing #1 (Basic Timing).......................... 137
Figure 58. Write Timing #2 (WE# Control).......................... 138
Figure 59. Write Timing #3-1 (WE#/LB#/UB# Byte Write
Control) ......................................................................... 138
Figure 60. Write Timing #3-2 (WE#/LB#/UB# Byte Write
Control) ......................................................................... 139
Figure 61. Write Timing #3-3 (WE#/LB#/UB# Byte Write
Control) ......................................................................... 139
Figure 62. Write Timing #3-4 (WE#/LB#/UB# Byte Write
Control) ......................................................................... 140
Read/Write Timings ..........................................................................................140
Figure 63. Read/Write Timing #1-1 (CE1# Control) ............. 140
Figure 64. Read / Write Timing #1-2 (CE1#/WE#/OE#
Control) ......................................................................... 141
Figure 65. Read / Write Timing #2 (OE#, WE# Control) ....... 141
Figure 66. Read / Write Timing #3 (OE#, WE#, LB#, UB#
Control) ......................................................................... 142
Figure 67. Power-up Timing #1 ......................................... 142
Figure 68. Power-up Timing #2 ......................................... 143
Figure 69. Power Down Entry and Exit Timing ..................... 143
Figure 70. Standby Entry Timing after Read or Write............ 143
Figure 71. Power Down Program Timing (for 32M/64M Only). 144
SRAM
Common Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
Pin Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
4M Version F, 4M version G, 8M version C .........................................147
Byte Mode ............................................................................................................147
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148
8M Version D .................................................................................................148
X means don’t care (must be low or high
state). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148
Absolute Maximum Ratings (4M Version F) . . . 148
Absolute Maximum Ratings (4M Version G, 8M
Version C, 8M Version D) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148
DC Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
Recommended DC Operating Conditions (Note 1) ..............................149
Capacitance (f=1MHz, T
A
=25
°
C) ..................................................................149
DC Operating Characteristics ......................................................................149
Common ..........................................................................................................149
DC Operating Characteristics ......................................................................150
4M Version F ..................................................................................................150
DC Operating Characteristics ......................................................................150
4M Version G .................................................................................................150
DC Operating Characteristics .......................................................................151
8M Version C ..................................................................................................151
DC Operating Characteristics .......................................................................151
8M Version D ..................................................................................................151
AC Operating Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
Test Conditions .................................................................................................152
Figure 72. AC Output Load................................................ 152
AC Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
Read/Write Characteristics (V
CC
=2.7-3.3V) .............................................152
Data Retention Characteristics (4M Version F) ......................................153
6S71PL254/127/064/032J_00A3 July 16, 2004
Advance Information
Data Retention Characteristics (4M Version G) .................................... 154
Data Retention Characteristics (8M Version C) .................................... 154
Data Retention Characteristics (8M Version D) .................................... 154
Timing Diagrams ................................................................................................ 154
Figure 73. Timing Waveform of Read Cycle(1) (Address
Controlled, CS#1=OE#=V
IL
, CS2=WE#=V
IH
, UB# and/or
LB#=V
IL
) ........................................................................ 154
Figure 74. Timing Waveform of Read Cycle(2) (WE#=V
IH
,
if BYTE# is Low, Ignore UB#/LB# Timing)........................... 155
Figure 75. Timing Waveform of Write Cycle(1) (WE#
controlled, if BYTE# is Low, Ignore UB#/LB# Timing) ........... 155
Figure 76. Timing Waveform of Write Cycle(2) (CS#
controlled, if BYTE# is Low, Ignore UB#/LB# Timing) ........... 156
Figure 77. Timing Waveform of Write Cycle(3) (UB#, LB#
controlled) ...................................................................... 156
Figure 78. Data Retention Waveform .................................. 157
pSRAM Type 1
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
Absolute Maximum Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
DC Characteristics (4Mb pSRAM
Asynchronous) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97
DC Characteristics (8Mb pSRAM
Asynchronous) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98
DC Characteristics (16Mb pSRAM
Asynchronous) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99
DC Characteristics (16Mb pSRAM Page
Mode) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
DC Characteristics (32Mb pSRAM Page
Mode) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
DC Characteristics (64Mb pSRAM Page
Mode) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Timing Test Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Output Load Circuit ........................................................................................ 103
Figure 79. Output Load Circuit ........................................... 103
Power Up Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
AC Characteristics (4Mb pSRAM Page
Mode) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
AC Characteristics (8Mb pSRAM
Asynchronous) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
AC Characteristics (16Mb pSRAM
Asynchronous) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
AC Characteristics (16Mb pSRAM Page
Mode) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
AC Characteristics (32Mb pSRAM Page
Mode) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112
AC Characteristics (64Mb pSRAM Page
Mode) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Timing Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Read Cycle ............................................................................................................115
Figure 80. Timing of Read Cycle (CE# = OE# = V
IL
, WE# =
ZZ# = V
IH
)..................................................................... 115
Figure 81. Timing Waveform of Read Cycle (WE# = ZZ# =
V
IH
) ............................................................................... 116
Figure 82. Timing Waveform of Page Mode Read Cycle (WE#
= ZZ# = V
IH
) ................................................................. 117
Write Cycle ..........................................................................................................118
Figure 83. Timing Waveform of Write Cycle (WE# Control,
ZZ# = V
IH
)..................................................................... 118
Figure 84. Timing Waveform of Write Cycle (CE# Control,
ZZ# = V
IH
)..................................................................... 118
Figure 85. Timing Waveform of Page Mode Write Cycle
(ZZ# = V
IH
) ................................................................... 119
Power Savings Modes (For 16M Page Mode,
32M and 64M Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Partial Array Self Refresh (PAR) ....................................................................119
Temperature Compensated Refresh (for 64Mb) ....................................120
Deep Sleep Mode ..............................................................................................120
Reduced Memory Size (for 32M and 16M) .................................................120
Other Mode Register Settings (for 64M) ...................................................120
Figure 86. Mode Register.................................................. 121
Figure 87. Mode Register Update Timings (UB#, LB#, OE# are
Don’t Care)..................................................................... 121
Figure 88. Deep Sleep Mode - Entry/Exit Timings................. 122
Mode Register Update and Deep Sleep
Timings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Address Patterns for PASR (A4=1) (64M) . . . . . 123
Deep ICC Characteristics (for 64Mb) . . . . . . . . . 124
Address Patterns for PAR (A3= 0, A4=1)
(32M) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Address Patterns for RMS (A3 = 1, A4 = 1)
(32M) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Low Power ICC Characteristics (32M) . . . . . . . . 125
Address Patterns for PAR (A3= 0, A4=1)
(16M) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Address Patterns for RMS (A3 = 1, A4 = 1)
(16M) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Low Power ICC Characteristics (16M) . . . . . . . . 125
July 16, 2004 S71PL254/127/064/032J_00_A4 7
Preliminary
MCP Block Diagram
Notes:
1. For 1 Flash + pSRAM, CE#f1=CE#. For 2 Flash + pSRAM, CE#=CE#f1 and CE#f2 is the chip-enable for the second
Flash.
2. For 256Mb only, Flash 1 = Flash 2 = S29PL127J.
VSS
RESET#
Flash 1
IO15-IO0
VCCf
DQ15 to DQ0
RY/BY#
WP#/ACC
VCC
VCC
CE#f1
Flash-only Address
Shared Address
OE#
WE#
Flash 2
(Note 2)
CE#f2
(Note 1)
VCCS
VCC
CE#s
UB#s
LB#s
CE#
UB#
LB#
pSRAM/SRAM
CE2
8S71PL254/127/064/032J_00_A4 July 16, 2004
Preliminary
Connection Diagram (S71PL032J)
Notes:
1. May be shared depending on density.
A19 is shared for the 16M pSRAM configuration.
A18 is shared for the 8M (p)SRAM and above configurations.
2. Connecting all Vcc and Vss balls to Vcc and Vss is recommended.
MCP Flash-only Addresses Shared Addresses
S71PL032JA0 A20 A19-A0
S71PL032J80 A20-A19 A18-A0
S71PL032J08 A20-A19 A18-A0
S71PL032J40 A20-A18 A17-A0
S71PL032J04 A20-A18 A17-A0
C3
UB#
D3
A18
E3
A17
F3
DQ1
G3
DQ9
H3
DQ10
DQ2
B3
LB#
C5
CE2s
A20
G5
DQ4
H5
VCCs
RFU
B5
WE#
C6
A19
D6
A9
E6
A10
F6
DQ6
G6
DQ13
H6
DQ12
DQ5
B6
A8
C4
RST#f
RY/BY#
G4
DQ3
H4
VCCf
DQ11
B4
WP/ACC
C7
A12
D7
A13
E7
A14
F7
RFU
G7
DQ15
H7
DQ7
DQ14
B7
A11
C8
A15
D8
RFU
E8
RFU
F8
A16
G8
RFU
VSS
C2
A6
D2
A5
E2
A4
F2
VSS
G2
OE#
H2
DQ0CE1#s
DQ8
B2
A7
C1
A3
D1
A2
E1
A1
F1
A0
G1
CE1#f
F5F4
B1 B8
A3 A5 A6A4 A7A2
RAM only
Shared
(Note 1)
Flash only
Legend
Reserved fo
r
Future Use
56-ball Fine-Pitch Ball Grid Array
(Top View, Balls Facing Down)
July 16, 2004 S71PL254/127/064/032J_00_A4 9
Preliminary
Connection Diagram (S71PL064J)
Notes:
1. May be shared depending on density.
A20 is shared for the 32M pSRAM configuration.
A19 is shared for the 16M pSRAM and above configurations.
A18 is shared for the 8M (p)SRAM and above configurations.
2. Connecting all Vcc and Vss balls to Vcc and Vss is recommended.
MCP Flash-only Addresses Shared Addresses
S71PL064JB0 A21 A20-A0
S71PL064JA0 A21-A20 A19-A0
S71PL064J80 A21-A19 A18-A0
S71PL064J08 A21-A19 A18-A0
C3
UB#
D3
A18
E3
A17
F3
DQ1
G3
DQ9
H3
DQ10
DQ2
B3
LB#
C5
CE2s
A20
G5
DQ4
H5
VCCs
RFU
B5
WE#
C6
A19
D6
A9
E6
A10
F6
DQ6
G6
DQ13
H6
DQ12
DQ5
B6
A8
C4
RST#f
RY/BY#
G4
DQ3
H4
VCCf
DQ11
B4
WP/ACC
C7
A12
D7
A13
E7
A14
F7
RFU
G7
DQ15
H7
DQ7
DQ14
B7
A11
C8
A15
D8
A21
E8
RFU
F8
A16
G8
RFU
VSS
C2
A6
D2
A5
E2
A4
F2
VSS
G2
OE#
H2
DQ0CE1#s
DQ8
B2
A7
C1
A3
D1
A2
E1
A1
F1
A0
G1
CE1#f
F5F4
B1 B8
A3 A5 A6A4 A7A2
RAM only
Shared
(Note 1)
Flash only
Legend
Reserved fo
r
Future Use
56-ball Fine-Pitch Ball Grid Array
(Top View, Balls Facing Down)
10 S71PL254/127/064/032J_00_A4 July 16, 2004
Preliminary
Connection Diagram (S71PL127J)
Notes:
1. May be shared depending on density.
A21 is shared for the 64M pSRAM configuration.
A20 is shared for the 32M pSRAM and above configurations.
1. A19 is shared for the 16M pSRAM and above configurations.
2. Connecting all Vcc & Vss balls to Vcc & Vss is recommended.
3. Ball L5 will be Vccf in the 84-ball density upgrades. Do not connect to Vss or any other signal.
MCP Flash-only Addresses Shared Addresses
S71PL127JC0 A22 A21-A0
S71PL127JB0 A22-A21 A20-A0
S71PL127JA0 A22-A20 A19-A0
E4
UB#
F4
A18
G4
A17
H4
DQ1
J4
DQ9
K4
DQ10
DQ2
D
4
E
6
CE2s
A20
J6
DQ4
K6
VCCs
RFU
D
6
RFU
E7
A19
F7
A9
G7
A10
H7
DQ6
J7
DQ13
K7
DQ12
DQ5
D
7
E5
RST#f
RY/BY#
J5
DQ3
K5
VCCf
DQ11
D5
RFU
E8
A12
F8
A13
G8
A14
H8
RFU
J8
DQ15
K8
DQ7
DQ14
D8
E
9
F9
A21
G9
A22
H9
A16
J9
RFU
VSS
E3
A6
F3
A5
G3
A4
H3
VSS
J3
OE#
K3
DQ0CE1#s
DQ8
D3
E2
F2
A2
G2
A1
H2
A0
J2
CE#f
H6H5
B6B5
RAM only
Shared
(Note 1)
Flash only
Legend
Reserved fo
r
Future Use
RFURFU*
L6L5
LB#
C
4
WE#
C6
A8
C7
WP/ACC
C5
A11
C8
A7
C3
A3
D2
A15
D9
A1
NC
A10
NC
M1 M10
NC NC
*See notes below
64-ball Fine-Pitch Ball Grid Array
(Top View, Balls Facing Down)
July 16, 2004 S71PL254/127/064/032J_00_A4 11
Preliminary
Connection Diagram (S71PL254J)
Notes:
1. May be shared depending on density.
A21 is shared for the 64M pSRAM configuration.
A20 is shared for the 32M pSRAM configuration.
2. Connecting all Vcc & Vss balls to Vcc & Vss is recommended.
Special Handling Instructions For FBGA Package
Special handling is required for Flash Memory products in FBGA packages.
Flash memory devices in FBGA packages may be damaged if exposed to ultra-
sonic cleaning methods. The package and/or data integrity may be compromised
MCP Flash-only Addresses Shared Addresses
S71PL254JC0 A22 A21-A0
S71PL254JB0 A22-A21 A20-A0
E4
UB#
F4
A18
G4
A17
H4
DQ1
J4
DQ9
DQ10
D
4
E
6
CE2s
A20
J6
DQ4
VCCs
D
6
E7
A19
F7
A9
G7
A10
H7
DQ6
J7
DQ13
DQ12
D7
E5
RST#f
RY/BY#
J5
DQ3
VCCf
D5
E8
A12
F8
A13
G8
A14
H8
RFU
J8
DQ15
DQ7
D8
E
9
F9
A21
G9
A22
H9
A16
J9
RFU
VSS
E3
A6
F3
A5
G3
A4
H3
VSS
J3
OE#
DQ0CE1#s
D3
E2
F2
A2
G2
A1
H2
A0
J2
CE#f1
H6H5
RAM only
Shared
(Note 1)
Flash only
Legend
Reserved fo
r
Future Use
A3
D2
A15
D9
A1
NC
A10
NC
M1 M10
NC NC
C
4
LB# WE#
C7
A8WP/ACC
C8
A11
C9
RFU
C3
A7
C2
RFU
C6C5
B4
RFU RFU
B7
RFUCE#F2
B8
RFU
B9
RFU
B3
RFU
B2
RFU
B6B5
L4
RFU RFU
L7
RFUVCCf
L8
RFU
L9
RFU
L3
RFU
L2
RFU
L6L5
K4
DQ2 RFU
K7
DQ5DQ11
K8
DQ14
K9
RFU
K3
DQ8
K2
RFU
K6K5
RFURFU
H6H5
RFURFU
H6H5
2nd Flash On
ly
84-ball Fine-Pitch Ball Grid Array
(Top View, Balls Facing Down)
12 S71PL254/127/064/032J_00_A4 July 16, 2004
Preliminary
if the package body is exposed to temperatures above 150°C for prolonged peri-
ods of time.
Pin Description
A21–A0 = 22 Address Inputs (Common)
DQ15–DQ0 = 16 Data Inputs/Outputs (Common)
CE1#f = Chip Enable 1 (Flash)
CE#f2 = Chip Enable 2 (Flash)
CE1#ps = Chip Enable 1 (pSRAM)
CE2ps = Chip Enable 2 (pSRAM)
OE# = Output Enable (Common)
WE# = Write Enable (Common)
RY/BY# = Ready/Busy Output (Flash 1)
UB# = Upper Byte Control (pSRAM)
LB# = Lower Byte Control (pSRAM)
RESET# = Hardware Reset Pin, Active Low (Flash 1)
WP#/ACC = Hardware Write Protect/Acceleration Pin (Flash)
VCCf = Flash 3.0 volt-only single power supply (see Product
Selector Guide for speed options and voltage supply
tolerances)
VCCps = pSRAM Power Supply
VSS = Device Ground (Common)
NC = Pin Not Connected Internally
Logic Symbol
22
16
DQ15–DQ0
A21–A0
CE1#f
OE#
WE#
RESET#
RY/BY#
WP#/ACC
UB#
CE2#f
CE2ps
CE1#ps
LB#
July 16, 2004 S71PL254/127/064/032J_00_A4 13
Preliminary
Ordering Information
The order number is formed by a valid combinations of the following:
S71PL 127 J B0 BA W 9 Z 0
PACKING TYPE
0=Tray
2 = 7” Tape and Reel
3 = 13” Tape and Reel
4 = 10” Tape and Reel
MODEL NUMBER
See the Valid Combinations table.
PACKAGE MODIFIER
0 = 7 x 9mm, 1.2mm height, 56 balls (TLC056)
9 = 8 x 11.6mm, 1.2mm height, 64 balls (TLA056)
T = 8 x 11.6mm, 1.4mm height, 84 balls (FTA084)
TEMPERATURE RANGE
W = Wireless (-25
°
C to +85
°
C)
I=Industrial (-40
°
C to +85
°
C)
PACKAGE TYPE
BA = Fine-pitch BGA Lead (Pb)-free compliant package
BF = Fine-pitch BGA Lead (Pb)-free package
pSRAM DENSITY
C0 = 64Mb pSRAM
B0 = 32Mb pSRAM
A0 = 16Mb pSRAM
80 = 8Mb pSRAM
40 = 4Mb pSRAM
08 = 8Mb SRAM
04 = 4Mb SRAM
PROCESS TECHNOLOGY
J = 110 nm, Floating Gate Technology
FLASH DENSITY
254 = 256Mb
127 = 128Mb
064 = 64Mb
032 = 32Mb
PRODUCT FAMILY
S71PL Multi-chip Product (MCP)
3.0-volt Simultaneous Read/Write, Page Mode Flash Memory and RAM
14 S71PL254/127/064/032J_00_A4 July 16, 2004
Preliminary
S71PL032J Valid Combinations
Speed Options
(ns)
(p)SRAM
Type/Access
Time (ns)
Package
Marking
Base Ordering
Part Number
Package &
Temperature
Package Modifier/
Model Number Packing Type
S71PL032J04
BAW
0B
0, 2, 3, 4 (Note 1)
65
SRAM2 / 70
(Note 2)
S71PL032J04 0F SRAM3 / 70
S71PL032J08 0B SRAM2 / 70
S71PL032J40 07 pSRAM1 / 70
S71PL032J80 07 pSRAM1 / 70
S71PL032J80 05 (Note 3) 55 pSRAM1 / 55
S71PL032JA0 07 65 pSRAM1 / 70
S71PL032JA0 0F 65 pSRAM3 / 70
S71PL032J04
BFW
0B
0, 2, 3, 4 (Note 1)
65
SRAM2 / 70
(Note 2)
S71PL032J04 0F SRAM3 / 70
S71PL032J08 0B SRAM2 / 70
S71PL032J40 07 pSRAM1 / 70
S71PL032J80 07 pSRAM1 / 70
S71PL032J80 05 (Note 3) 55 pSRAM1 / 55
S71PL032JA0 07 65 pSRAM1 / 70
S71PL032JA0 0F 65 pSRAM3 / 70
S71PL032J04
BAI
0B
0, 2, 3, 4 (Note 1)
65
SRAM2 / 70
(Note 2)
S71PL032J04 0F SRAM3 / 70
S71PL032J08 0B SRAM2 / 70
S71PL032J40 07 pSRAM1 / 70
S71PL032J80 07 pSRAM1 / 70
S71PL032J80 05 (Note 3) 55 pSRAM1 / 55
S71PL032JA0 07 65 pSRAM1 / 70
S71PL032JA0 0F 65 pSRAM3 / 70
S71PL032J04
BFI
0B
0, 2, 3, 4 (Note 1)
65
SRAM2 / 70
(Note 2)
S71PL032J04 0F SRAM3 / 70
S71PL032J08 0B SRAM2 / 70
S71PL032J40 07 pSRAM1 / 70
S71PL032J80 07 pSRAM1 / 70
S71PL032J80 05 (Note 3) 55 pSRAM1 / 55
S71PL032JA0 07 65 pSRAM1 / 70
S71PL032JA0 0F 65 pSRAM3 / 70
Notes:
1. Type 0 is standard. Specify other options as required.
2. BGA package marking omits leading “S” and packing type
designator from ordering part number.
3. Contact factory for availability.
Valid Combinations
Valid Combinations list configurations planned to be supported in vol-
ume for this device. Consult your local sales office to confirm avail-
ability of specific valid combinations and to check on newly released
combinations.
July 16, 2004 S71PL254/127/064/032J_00_A4 15
Preliminary
S71PL064J Valid Combinations
Speed Options
(ns)
(p)SRAM
Type/Access
Time (ns)
Package
Marking
Base Ordering
Part Number
Package &
Temperatur
e
Package Modifier/
Model Number Packing Type
S71PL064J08
BAW
0B
0, 2, 3, 4 (Note 1)
65
SRAM1 / 70
(Note 2)
S71PL064J08 0U SRAM3 / 70
S71PL064J80 0K pSRAM1 /70
S71PL064JA0 07 pSRAM1 / 70
S71PL064JA0 0P pSRAM7 / 70
S71PL064JB0 07 pSRAM1 / 70
S71PL064JB0 0U pSRAM6 / 70
S71PL064J80 05 (Note 3) 55 pSRAM1 / 55
S71PL064JA0 05 (Note 3) pSRAM1 / 55
S71PL064J08
BFW
0B
0, 2, 3, 4 (Note 1)
65
SRAM1 / 70
(Note 2)
S71PL064J08 0U SRAM3 / 70
S71PL064J80 0K pSRAM1 /70
S71PL064JA0 07 pSRAM1 / 70
S71PL064JA0 0P pSRAM7 / 70
S71PL064JB0 07 pSRAM1 / 70
S71PL064JB0 0U pSRAM6 / 70
S71PL064J80 05 (Note 3) 55 pSRAM1 / 55
S71PL064JA0 05 (Note 3) pSRAM1 / 55
S71PL064J08
BAI
0B
0, 2, 3, 4 (Note 1)
65
SRAM1 / 70
(Note 2)
S71PL064J08 0U SRAM3 / 70
S71PL064J80 0K pSRAM1 /70
S71PL064JA0 07 pSRAM1 / 70
S71PL064JA0 0P pSRAM7 / 70
S71PL064JB0 0U pSRAM6 / 70
S71PL064J80 05 (Note 3) 55 pSRAM1 / 55
S71PL064JA0 05 (Note 3) pSRAM1 / 55
S71PL064J08
BFI
0B
0, 2, 3, 4 (Note 1)
65
SRAM1 / 70
(Note 2)
S71PL064J08 0U SRAM3 / 70
S71PL064J80 0K pSRAM1 /70
S71PL064JA0 07 pSRAM1 / 70
S71PL064JA0 0P pSRAM7 / 70
S71PL064JB0 0U pSRAM6 / 70
S71PL064J80 05 (Note 3) 55 pSRAM1 / 55
S71PL064JA0 05 (Note 3) pSRAM1 / 55
Notes:
1. Type 0 is standard. Specify other options as required.
2. BGA package marking omits leading “S” and packing type
designator from ordering part number.
3. Contact factory for availability.
Valid Combinations
Valid Combinations list configurations planned to be supported in vol-
ume for this device. Consult your local sales office to confirm avail-
ability of specific valid combinations and to check on newly released
combinations.
16 S71PL254/127/064/032J_00_A4 July 16, 2004
Preliminary
S71PL127J Valid Combinations
Speed Options
(ns)
(p)SRAM
Type/Access
Time (ns)
Package
Marking
Base Ordering
Part Number
Package &
Temperature
Package
Modifier/Model
Number
Packing Type
S71PL127JA0
BAW
9P
0, 2, 3, 4 (Note 1) 65
pSRAM7 / 70
(Note 2)
S71PL127JB0 97 pSRAM1 / 70
S71PL127JB0 9Z pSRAM7 / 70
S71PL127JB0 9U pSRAM6 /70
S71PL127JC0 97 pSRAM1 /70
S71PL127JC0 9Z pSRAM7 / 70
S71PL127JC0 9U pSRAM6 / 70
S71PL127JA0
BFW
9P
0, 2, 3, 4 65
pSRAM7 / 70
(Note 2)
S71PL127JB0 97 pSRAM1 / 70
S71PL127JB0 9Z pSRAM7 / 70
S71PL127JB0 9U pSRAM6 / 70
S71PL127JC0 97 pSRAM1 /70
S71PL127JC0 9Z pSRAM7 / 70
S71PL127JC0 9U pSRAM6 / 70
S71PL127JA0
BAI
9P
0, 2, 3, 4 (Note 1) 65
pSRAM7 / 70
(Note 2)
S71PL127JB0 97 pSRAM1 / 70
S71PL127JB0 9Z pSRAM7 / 70
S71PL127JB0 9U pSRAM6 / 70
S71PL127JC0 97 pSRAM1 /70
S71PL127JC0 9Z pSRAM7 / 70
S71PL127JC0 9U pSRAM6 / 70
S71PL127JA0
BFI
9P
0, 2, 3, 4 (Note 1) 65
pSRAM7 / 70
(Note 2)
S71PL127JB0 97 pSRAM1 / 70
S71PL127JB0 9Z pSRAM7 / 70
S71PL127JB0 9U pSRAM6 / 70
S71PL127JC0 97 pSRAM1 /70
S71PL127JC0 9Z pSRAM7 / 70
S71PL127JC0 9U pSRAM6 / 70
Notes:
1. Type 0 is standard. Specify other options as required.
2. BGA package marking omits leading “S” and packing type
designator from ordering part number.
Valid Combinations
Valid Combinations list configurations planned to be supported in vol-
ume for this device. Consult your local sales office to confirm avail-
ability of specific valid combinations and to check on newly released
combinations.
July 16, 2004 S71PL254/127/064/032J_00_A4 17
Preliminary
S71PL254J Valid Combinations
Speed Options
(ns)
(p)SRAM
Type/Access
Time (ns)
Package
Marking
Base Ordering
Part Number
Package &
Temperature Model Number Packing Type
S71PL254JB0
BAW
T7
0, 2, 3, 4 (Note 1) 65
pSRAM1 / 70
(Note 2)
S71PL254JB0 TB pSRAM2 /70
S71PL254JB0 TU pSRAM6 / 70
S71PL254JC0 TB pSRAM2 / 70
S71PL254JC0 TU pSRAM6 /70
S71PL254JC0 TZ pSRAM7 / 70
S71PL254JB0
BFW
T7
0, 2, 3, 4 (Note 1) 65
pSRAM1 / 70
(Note 2)
S71PL254JB0 TB pSRAM2 /70
S71PL254JB0 TU pSRAM6 / 70
S71PL254JC0 TB pSRAM2 / 70
S71PL254JC0 TU pSRAM6 / 70
S71PL254JC0 TZ pSRAM7 / 70
S71PL254JB0
BAI
T7
0, 2, 3, 4 (Note 1) 65
pSRAM1 / 70
(Note 2)
S71PL254JB0 TB pSRAM2 /70
S71PL254JB0 TU pSRAM6 / 70
S71PL254JC0 TB pSRAM2 / 70
S71PL254JC0 TU pSRAM6 / 70
S71PL254JC0 TZ pSRAM7 / 70
S71PL254JB0
BFI
T7
0, 2, 3, 4 (Note 1) 65
pSRAM1 / 70
(Note 2)
S71PL254JB0 TB pSRAM2 /70
S71PL254JB0 TU pSRAM6 / 70
S71PL254JC0 TB pSRAM2 / 70
S71PL254JC0 TU pSRAM6 / 70
S71PL254JC0 TZ pSRAM7 / 70
Notes:
1. Type 0 is standard. Specify other options as required.
2. BGA package marking omits leading “S” and packing type
designator from ordering part number.
Valid Combinations
Valid Combinations list configurations planned to be supported in vol-
ume for this device. Consult your local sales office to confirm avail-
ability of specific valid combinations and to check on newly released
combinations.
18 S71PL254/127/064/032J_00_A4 July 16, 2004
Preliminary
Physical Dimensions
TLC056—56-ball Fine-Pitch Ball Grid Array (FBGA)
9 x 7mm Package
3348 \ 16-038.22
a
PACKAGE TLC 056
JEDEC N/A
D x E 9.00 mm x 7.00 mm
PACKAGE
SYMBOL MIN NOM MAX NOTE
A --- --- 1.20 PROFILE
A1 0.20 --- --- BALL HEIGHT
A2 0.81 --- 0.97 BODY THICKNESS
D 9.00 BSC. BODY SIZE
E 7.00 BSC. BODY SIZE
D1 5.60 BSC. MATRIX FOOTPRINT
E1 5.60 BSC. MATRIX FOOTPRINT
MD 8 MATRIX SIZE D DIRECTION
ME 8 MATRIX SIZE E DIRECTION
n 56 BALL COUNT
φb 0.35 0.40 0.45 BALL DIAMETER
eE 0.80 BSC. BALL PITCH
eD 0.80 BSC BALL PITCH
SD / SE 0.40 BSC. SOLDER BALL PLACEMENT
A1,A8,D4,D5,E4,E5,H1,H8 DEPOPULATED SOLDER BALLS
NOTES:
1. DIMENSIONING AND TOLERANCING METHODS PER
ASME Y14.5M-1994.
2. ALL DIMENSIONS ARE IN MILLIMETERS.
3. BALL POSITION DESIGNATION PER JESD 95-1, SPP-010.
4. e REPRESENTS THE SOLDER BALL GRID PITCH.
5. SYMBOL "MD" IS THE BALL MATRIX SIZE IN THE "D"
DIRECTION.
SYMBOL "ME" IS THE BALL MATRIX SIZE IN THE
"E" DIRECTION.
n IS THE NUMBER OF POPULTED SOLDER BALL POSITIONS
FOR MATRIX SIZE MD X ME.
6 DIMENSION "b" IS MEASURED AT THE MAXIMUM BALL
DIAMETER IN A PLANE PARALLEL TO DATUM C.
7 SD AND SE ARE MEASURED WITH RESPECT TO DATUMS A
AND B AND DEFINE THE POSITION OF THE CENTER SOLDER
BALL IN THE OUTER ROW.
WHEN THERE IS AN ODD NUMBER OF SOLDER BALLS IN THE
OUTER ROW SD OR SE = 0.000.
WHEN THERE IS AN EVEN NUMBER OF SOLDER BALLS IN TH
E
OUTER ROW, SD OR SE = e/2
8. "+" INDICATES THE THEORETICAL CENTER OF DEPOPULATED
BALLS.
9. N/A
10 A1 CORNER TO BE IDENTIFIED BY CHAMFER, LASER OR INK
MARK, METALLIZED MARK INDENTATION OR OTHER MEANS.
E1
7
SE
A
D1
eD
DCEFGH
8
7
6
4
3
2
1
eE
5
B
PIN A1
CORNER
7
SD
BOTTOM VIEW
C
0.08
0.20 C
A
E
B
C
0.15
(2X)
C
D
C
0.15
(2X)
INDEX MARK
10
6b
TOP VIEW
SIDE VIEW
CORNER
56X
A1
A2
A
0.15 M
MC
CAB
0.08
PIN A1
July 16, 2004 S71PL254/127/064/032J_00_A4 19
Preliminary
TLA064—64-ball Fine-Pitch Ball Grid Array (FBGA)
8 x 11.6mm Package
3352 \ 16-038.22
a
PACKAGE TLA 064
JEDEC N/A
D x E 11.60 mm x 8.00 mm
PACKAGE
SYMBOL MIN NOM MAX NOTE
A --- --- 1.20 PROFILE
A1 0.17 --- --- BALL HEIGHT
A2 0.81 --- 0.97 BODY THICKNESS
D 11.60 BSC. BODY SIZE
E 8.00 BSC. BODY SIZE
D1 8.80 BSC. MATRIX FOOTPRINT
E1 7.20 BSC. MATRIX FOOTPRINT
MD 12 MATRIX SIZE D DIRECTION
ME 10 MATRIX SIZE E DIRECTION
n 64 BALL COUNT
φb 0.35 0.40 0.45 BALL DIAMETER
eE 0.80 BSC. BALL PITCH
eD 0.80 BSC BALL PITCH
SD / SE 0.40 BSC. SOLDER BALL PLACEMENT
A2,A3,A4,A5,A6,A7,A8,A9 DEPOPULATED SOLDER BALLS
B1,B2,B3,B4,B7,B8,B9,B10
C1,C2,C9,C10,D1,D10,E1,E10,
F1,F5,F6,F10,G1,G5,G6,G10
H1,H10,J1,J10,K1,K2,K9,K10
L1,L2,L3,L4,L7,L8,L9,L10
M2,M3,M4,M5,M6,M7,M8,M9
NOTES:
1. DIMENSIONING AND TOLERANCING METHODS PER
ASME Y14.5M-1994.
2. ALL DIMENSIONS ARE IN MILLIMETERS.
3. BALL POSITION DESIGNATION PER JESD 95-1, SPP-010.
4. e REPRESENTS THE SOLDER BALL GRID PITCH.
5. SYMBOL "MD" IS THE BALL MATRIX SIZE IN THE "D"
DIRECTION.
SYMBOL "ME" IS THE BALL MATRIX SIZE IN THE
"E" DIRECTION.
n IS THE NUMBER OF POPULTED SOLDER BALL POSITIONS
FOR MATRIX SIZE MD X ME.
6 DIMENSION "b" IS MEASURED AT THE MAXIMUM BALL
DIAMETER IN A PLANE PARALLEL TO DATUM C.
7 SD AND SE ARE MEASURED WITH RESPECT TO DATUMS A
AND B AND DEFINE THE POSITION OF THE CENTER SOLDER
BALL IN THE OUTER ROW.
WHEN THERE IS AN ODD NUMBER OF SOLDER BALLS IN THE
OUTER ROW SD OR SE = 0.000.
WHEN THERE IS AN EVEN NUMBER OF SOLDER BALLS IN THE
OUTER ROW, SD OR SE = e/2
8. "+" INDICATES THE THEORETICAL CENTER OF DEPOPULATED
BALLS.
9. N/A
10 A1 CORNER TO BE IDENTIFIED BY CHAMFER, LASER OR INK
MARK, METALLIZED MARK INDENTATION OR OTHER MEANS.
C
0.20
C
0.08
C
b
64X 6
0.08 M C
0.15 M C A B
A2
A
A1 SIDE VIEW
L
M
eD
CORNER
E1
7
SE
D1
ABDCEFHG
10
8
9
7
5
6
4
2
3
J
K
1
eE
SD
BOTTOM VIEW
PIN A1
7
10
INDEX MARK
C
0.15
(2X)
(2X) C
0.15
B
A
D
E
PIN A1
TOP VIEW
CORNER
20 S71PL254/127/064/032J_00_A4 July 16, 2004
Preliminary
FTA084—84-ball Fine-Pitch Ball Grid Array (FBGA)
8 x 11.6mm
3388 \ 16-038.21
a
PACKAGE FTA 084
JEDEC N/A
D x E 11.60 mm x 8.00 mm NOTE
PACKAGE
SYMBOL MIN NOM MAX
A --- --- 1.40 PROFILE
A1 0.17 --- --- BALL HEIGHT
A2 1.02 --- 1.17 BODY THICKNESS
D 11.60 BSC. BODY SIZE
E 8.00 BSC. BODY SIZE
D1 8.80 BSC. MATRIX FOOTPRINT
E1 7.20 BSC. MATRIX FOOTPRINT
MD 12 MATRIX SIZE D DIRECTION
ME 10 MATRIX SIZE E DIRECTION
n 84 BALL COUNT
φb 0.35 0.40 0.45 BALL DIAMETER
eE 0.80 BSC. BALL PITCH
eD 0.80 BSC BALL PITCH
SD / SE 0.40 BSC. SOLDER BALL PLACEMENT
A2,A3,A4,A5,A6,A7,A8,A9 DEPOPULATED SOLDER BALLS
B1,B10,C1,C10,D1,D10,E1,E10
F1,F10,G1,G10,H1,H10
J1,J10,K1,K10,L1,L10
M2,M3,M4,M5,M6,M7,M8,M9
NOTES:
1. DIMENSIONING AND TOLERANCING METHODS PER
ASME Y14.5M-1994.
2. ALL DIMENSIONS ARE IN MILLIMETERS.
3. BALL POSITION DESIGNATION PER JESD 95-1, SPP-010.
4. e REPRESENTS THE SOLDER BALL GRID PITCH.
5. SYMBOL "MD" IS THE BALL MATRIX SIZE IN THE "D"
DIRECTION.
SYMBOL "ME" IS THE BALL MATRIX SIZE IN THE
"E" DIRECTION.
n IS THE NUMBER OF POPULTED SOLDER BALL POSITIONS
FOR MATRIX SIZE MD X ME.
6 DIMENSION "b" IS MEASURED AT THE MAXIMUM BALL
DIAMETER IN A PLANE PARALLEL TO DATUM C.
7 SD AND SE ARE MEASURED WITH RESPECT TO DATUMS A
AND B AND DEFINE THE POSITION OF THE CENTER SOLDER
BALL IN THE OUTER ROW.
WHEN THERE IS AN ODD NUMBER OF SOLDER BALLS IN THE
OUTER ROW SD OR SE = 0.000.
WHEN THERE IS AN EVEN NUMBER OF SOLDER BALLS IN TH
E
OUTER ROW, SD OR SE = e/2
8. "+" INDICATES THE THEORETICAL CENTER OF DEPOPULATED
BALLS.
9. N/A
10 A1 CORNER TO BE IDENTIFIED BY CHAMFER, LASER OR INK
MARK, METALLIZED MARK INDENTATION OR OTHER MEANS.
(2X)
C
0.08
0.20 C
C
6
bSIDE VIEW
84X
A1
A2
A
0.15 M C
MCAB
0.08
BOTTOM VIEW
ML
E1
7
SE
A
D1
eD
DCEFGHJ
K
10
8
9
7
6
4
3
2
1
eE
5
B
PIN A1
CORNER
7
SD
A
E
B
C
0.15
D
C
0.15
(2X)
INDEX MARK
10 TOP VIEW
CORNER
PIN A1
Publication Number S29PL127_064_032J_00_ Revision A Amendment 1 Issue Date May 21, 2004
PRELIMINARY
S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for
MCP
128/128/64/32 Megabit (8/4/2 M x 16-Bit)
CMOS 3.0 Volt-only, Simultaneous Read/Write
Flash Memory with Enhanced VersatileIOTM Control
Distinctive Characteristics
ARCHITECTURAL ADVANTAGES
128/64/32Mbit Page Mode devices
Page size of 8 words: Fast page read access from
random locations within the page
Single power supply operation
Full Voltage range: 2.7 to 3.6 volt read, erase, and
program operations for battery-powered applications
Simultaneous Read/Write Operation
Data can be continuously read from one bank while
executing erase/program functions in another bank
Zero latency switching from write to read operations
FlexBank Architecture (PL127J/PL064J/PL032J)
4 separate banks, with up to two simultaneous
operations per device
—Bank A:
PL127J -16Mbit (4 Kw x 8 and 32 Kw x 31)
PL064J - 8Mbit (4 Kw x 8 and 32 Kw x 15)
PL032J - 4Mbit (4 Kw x 8 and 32 Kw x 7)
—Bank B:
PL127J - 48Mbit (32 Kw x 96)
PL064J - 24Mbit (32 Kw x 48)
PL032J - 12 Mbit (32 Kw x 24)
—Bank C:
PL127J - 48Mbit (32 Kw x 96)
PL064J - 24Mbit (32 Kw x 48)
PL032J - 12 Mbit (32 Kw x 24)
—Bank D:
PL127J -16Mbit (4 Kw x 8 and 32 Kw x 31)
PL064J - 8Mbit (4 Kw x 8 and 32 Kw x 15)
PL032J - 4Mbit (4 Kw x 8 and 32 Kw x 7)
Enhanced VersatileI/OTM (VIO) Control
Output voltage generated and input voltages
tolerated on all control inputs and I/Os is determined
by the voltage on the VIO pin
—V
IO options at 1.8 V and 3 V I/O for PL127J devices
—3V V
IO for PL064J and PL032J devices
SecSiTM (Secured Silicon) Sector region
Up to 128 words accessible through a command
sequence
Up to 64 factory-locked words
Up to 64 customer-lockable words
Both top and bottom boot blocks in one device
Manufactured on 110 nm process technology
Data Retention: 20 years typical
Cycling Endurance: 1 million cycles per sector
typical
PERFORMANCE CHARACTERISTICS
High Performance
Page access times as fast as 20 ns
Random access times as fast as 55 ns
Power consumption (typical values at 10 MHz)
45 mA active read current
17 mA program/erase current
0.2 µA typical standby mode current
SOFTWARE FEATURES
Software command-set compatible with JEDEC
42.4 standard
Backward compatible with Am29F, Am29LV, Am29DL,
and AM29PDL families and MBM29QM/RM, MBM29LV,
MBM29DL, MBM29PDL families
CFI (Common Flash Interface) compliant
Provides device-specific information to the system,
allowing host software to easily reconfigure for
different Flash devices
Erase Suspend / Erase Resume
Suspends an erase operation to allow read or program
operations in other sectors of same bank
Unlock Bypass Program command
Reduces overall programming time when issuing
multiple program command sequences
22 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
HARDWARE FEATURES
Ready/Busy# pin (RY/BY#)
Provides a hardware method of detecting program or erase cycle completion
Hardware reset pin (RESET#)
Hardware method to reset the device to reading array data
WP#/ ACC (Write Protect/Acceleration) input
—At V
IL, hardware level protection for the first and last two 4K word sectors.
—At V
IH, allows removal of sector protection
—At V
HH, provides accelerated programming in a factory setting
Persistent Sector Protection
A command sector protection method to lock combinations of individual sectors and sector groups to prevent program
or erase operations within that sector
Sectors can be locked and unlocked in-system at VCC level
Password Sector Protection
A sophisticated sector protection method to lock combinations of individual sectors and sector groups to prevent
program or erase operations within that sector using a user-defined 64-bit password
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 23
Preliminary
General Description
The PL127J/PL064J/PL032J is a 128/128/64/32Mbit, 3.0 volt-only Page Mode and
Simultaneous Read/Write Flash memory device organized as 8/8/4/2 Mwords.
The word-wide data (x16) appears on DQ15-DQ0. This device can be pro-
grammed in-system or in standard EPROM programmers. A 12.0 V VPP is not
required for write or erase operations.
The device offers fast page access times of 20 to 30 ns, with corresponding ran-
dom access times of 55 to 70 ns, respectively, allowing high speed
microprocessors to operate without wait states. To eliminate bus contention the
device has separate chip enable (CE#), write enable (WE#) and output enable
(OE#) controls.
Simultaneous Read/Write Operation with Zero Latency
The Simultaneous Read/Write architecture provides simultaneous operation
by dividing the memory space into 4 banks, which can be considered to be four
separate memory arrays as far as certain operations are concerned. The device
can improve overall system performance by allowing a host system to program
or erase in one bank, then immediately and simultaneously read from another
bank with zero latency (with two simultaneous operations operating at any one
time). This releases the system from waiting for the completion of a program or
erase operation, greatly improving system performance.
The device can be organized in both top and bottom sector configurations. The
banks are organized as follows:
Page Mode Features
The page size is 8 words. After initial page access is accomplished, the page mode
operation provides fast read access speed of random locations within that page.
Standard Flash Memory Features
The device requires a single 3.0 volt power supply (2.7 V to 3.6 V) for both
read and write functions. Internally generated and regulated voltages are pro-
vided for the program and erase operations.
The device is entirely command set compatible with the JEDEC 42.4 single-
power-supply Flash standard. Commands are written to the command regis-
ter using standard microprocessor write timing. Register contents serve as inputs
to an internal state-machine that controls the erase and programming circuitry.
Write cycles also internally latch addresses and data needed for the programming
and erase operations. Reading data out of the device is similar to reading from
other Flash or EPROM devices.
Bank PL127J Sectors PL064J Sectors PL032J Sectors
A16Mbit (4 Kw x 8 and 32 Kw x 31) 8Mbit (4 Kw x 8 and 32 Kw x 15) 4Mbit (4 Kw x 8 and 32 Kw x 7)
B48Mbit (32 Kw x 96) 24Mbit (32 Kw x 48) 12 Mbit (32 Kw x 24)
C48Mbit (32 Kw x 96) 24Mbit (32 Kw x 48) 12 Mbit (32 Kw x 24)
D16Mbit (4 Kw x 8 and 32 Kw x 31) 8Mbit (4 Kw x 8 and 32 Kw x 15) 4Mbit (4 Kw x 8 and 32 Kw x 7)
24 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
Device programming occurs by executing the program command sequence. The
Unlock Bypass mode facilitates faster programming times by requiring only two
write cycles to program data instead of four. Device erasure occurs by executing
the erase command sequence.
The host system can detect whether a program or erase operation is complete by
reading the DQ7 (Data# Polling) and DQ6 (toggle) status bits. After a program
or erase cycle has been completed, the device is ready to read array data or ac-
cept another command.
The sector erase architecture allows memory sectors to be erased and repro-
grammed without affecting the data contents of other sectors. The device is fully
erased when shipped from the factory.
Hardware data protection measures include a low VCC detector that automat-
ically inhibits write operations during power transitions. The hardware sector
protection feature disables both program and erase operations in any combina-
tion of sectors of memory. This can be achieved in-system or via programming
equipment.
The Erase Suspend/Erase Resume feature enables the user to put erase on
hold for any period of time to read data from, or program data to, any sector that
is not selected for erasure. True background erase can thus be achieved. If a read
is needed from the SecSi Sector area (One Time Program area) after an erase
suspend, then the user must use the proper command sequence to enter and exit
this region.
The device offers two power-saving features. When addresses have been stable
for a specified amount of time, the device enters the automatic sleep mode.
The system can also place the device into the standby mode. Power consumption
is greatly reduced in both these modes.
The device electrically erases all bits within a sector simultaneously via Fowler-
Nordheim tunneling. The data is programmed using hot electron injection.
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 25
Preliminary
Product Selector Guide
Note: Contact factory for availability
Part Number
S29PL032J/S29PL064J/S29PL127J/064J/032J
Speed Option
V
CC
,V
IO
= 2.7–3.6 V 55 (Note) 60 65 70
V
CC
= 2.7–3.6 V,
V
IO
= 1.65–1.95 V (PL127J only) 65 70
Max Access Time, ns (t
ACC
)
55 (Note) 60 65 65 70 70
Max CE# Access, ns (t
CE
)
Max Page Access, ns (t
PACC
)
20 (Note) 25 25 30 30 30
Max OE# Access, ns (t
OE
)
26 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
Block Diagram
Notes:
1. RY/BY# is an open drain output.
2. Amax = A22 (PL127J), A21 (PL064J), A20 (PL032J)
V
CC
V
SS
State
Control
Command
Register PGM Voltage
Generator
V
CC
Detector Timer
Erase Voltage
Generator
Input/Output
Buffers
Sector
Switches
Chip Enable
Output Enable
Logic
Y-Gating
Cell Matrix
Address Latch
Y-Decoder
X-Decoder
Data Latch
RESET#
RY/BY# (See Note)
max–A3
A2–A0
CE#
WE#
V
IO
OE#
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 27
Preliminary
Simultaneous Read/Write Block Diagram
Note: Amax = A22 (PL127J), A21 (PL064J), A20 (PL032J)
Note: Pinout shown for PL127J.
V
CC
V
SS
Bank A Address
Bank B Address
Amax–A0
RESET#
WE#
CE#
DQ0–DQ15
STATE
CONTROL
&
COMMAND
REGISTER
RY/BY#
Bank A
X-Decoder
OE#
DQ15–DQ0
Status
Control
Amax–A0
Amax–A0
A22–A0A22–A0
DQ15–DQ0
DQ15–DQ0
DQ15–DQ0
DQ15–DQ0
Mux
Mux
Mux
Bank B
X-Decoder
Y-gate
Bank C
X-Decoder
Bank D
X-Decoder
Y-gate
Bank C Address
Bank D Address
WP#/ACC
28 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
Pin Description
AmaxA0 = Address bus
DQ15–DQ0 = 16-bit data inputs/outputs/float
CE# = Chip Enable Inputs
OE# = Output Enable Input
WE# = Write Enable
VSS = Device Ground
NC = Pin Not Connected Internally
RY/BY# = Ready/Busy output and open drain.
When RY/BY#= VIH, the device is ready to accept
read operations and commands. When RY/BY#=
VOL, the device is either executing an embedded
algorithm or the device is executing a hardware
reset operation.
WP#/ACC = Write Protect/Acceleration Input.
When WP#/ACC= VIL, the highest and lowest two
4K-word sectors are write protected regardless of
other sector protection configurations. When WP#/
ACC= VIH, these sector are unprotected unless the
DYB or PPB is programmed. When WP#/ACC= 12V,
program and erase operations are accelerated.
VIO = Input/Output Buffer Power Supply
(1.65 V to 1.95 V (for PL127J) or 2.7 V to 3.6 V (for
all PLxxxJ devices)
VCC = Chip Power Supply
(2.7 V to 3.6 V or 2.7 to 3.3 V)
RESET# = Hardware Reset Pin
CE#1 = Chip Enable Inputs
Notes:
1. Amax = A22 (PL127J), A21 (PL064J), A20 (PL032J)
Logic Symbol
max+1
16
DQ15–DQ0
Amax–A0
CE#
OE#
WE#
RESET# RY/BY#
WP#/ACC
V
IO
(V
CCQ
)
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 29
Preliminary
Device Bus Operations
This section describes the requirements and use of the device bus operations,
which are initiated through the internal command register. The command register
itself does not occupy any addressable memory location. The register is a latch
used to store the commands, along with the address and data information
needed to execute the command. The contents of the register serve as inputs to
the internal state machine. The state machine outputs dictate the function of the
device. Tab l e 1 lists the device bus operations, the inputs and control levels they
require, and the resulting output. The following subsections describe each of
these operations in further detail.
Legend: L= Logic Low = VIL, H = Logic High = VIH, VID = 11.5-12.5 V, VHH = 8.5-9.5 V, X = Don’t Care, SA =
Sector Address, AIN = Address In, DIN = Data In, DOUT = Data Out
Notes:
1. The sector protect and sector unprotect functions may also be implemented via programming equipment. See the
High Voltage Sector Protection section.
2. WP#/ACC must be high when writing to upper two and lower two sectors.
Requirements for Reading Array Data
To read array data from the outputs, the system must drive the OE# and appro-
priate CE# pins. OE# is the output control and gates array data to the output
pins. WE# should remain at VIH.
The internal state machine is set for reading array data upon device power-up,
or after a hardware reset. This ensures that no spurious alteration of the memory
content occurs during the power transition. No command is necessary in this
mode to obtain array data. Standard microprocessor read cycles that assert valid
addresses on the device address inputs produce valid data on the device data
outputs. Each bank remains enabled for read access until the command register
contents are altered.
Refer to Ta b l e 23 for timing specifications and to Figure 11 for the timing diagram.
ICC1 in the DC Characteristics table represents the active current specification for
reading array data.
Random Read (Non-Page Read)
Address access time (tACC) is equal to the delay from stable addresses to valid
output data. The chip enable access time (tCE) is the delay from the stable ad-
dresses and stable CE# to valid data at the output inputs. The output enable
Ta b l e 1 . PL127J Device Bus Operations
Operation CE# OE# WE# RESET# WP#/ACC
Addresses
(Amax–A0)
DQ15
DQ0
Read L L H H X A
IN
D
OUT
Write L H L H X (Note 2) A
IN
D
IN
Standby V
IO
±
0.3 V X X V
IO
±
0.3 V X (Note 2) X High-Z
Output Disable L H H H X X High-Z
Reset X X X L X X High-Z
Temporary Sector Unprotect (High Voltage) X X X V
ID
X A
IN
D
IN
30 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
access time is the delay from the falling edge of the OE# to valid data at the out-
put inputs (assuming the addresses have been stable for at least tACC–tOE time).
Page Mode Read
The device is capable of fast page mode read and is compatible with the page
mode Mask ROM read operation. This mode provides faster read access speed for
random locations within a page. Address bits Amax–A3 select an 8 word page,
and address bits A2–A0 select a specific word within that page. This is an asyn-
chronous operation with the microprocessor supplying the specific word location.
The random or initial page access is tACC or tCE and subsequent page read ac-
cesses (as long as the locations specified by the microprocessor falls within that
page) is equivalent to tPACC. Fast page mode accesses are obtained by keeping
Amax–A3 constant and changing A2–A0 to select the specific word within that
page.
Simultaneous Read/Write Operation
In addition to the conventional features (read, program, erase-suspend read, and
erase-suspend program), the device is capable of reading data from one bank of
memory while a program or erase operation is in progress in another bank of
memory (simultaneous operation). The bank can be selected by bank addresses
(PL127J: A22–A20, L064J: A21–A19, PL032J: A20–A18) with zero latency.
The simultaneous operation can execute multi-function mode in the same bank.
Ta b l e 2 . Page Select
Word A2 A1 A0
Word 0 0 0 0
Word 1 0 0 1
Word 2 0 1 0
Word 3 0 1 1
Word 4 1 0 0
Word 5 1 0 1
Word 6 1 1 0
Word 7 1 1 1
Table 3. Bank Select
Bank
PL127J: A22–A20
PL064J: A21–A19
PL032J: A20–A18
Bank A 000
Bank B 001, 010, 011
Bank C 100, 101, 110
Bank D 111
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 31
Preliminary
Writing Commands/Command Sequences
To write a command or command sequence (which includes programming data
to the device and erasing sectors of memory), the system must drive WE# and
CE# to VIL, and OE# to VIH.
The device features an Unlock Bypass mode to facilitate faster programming.
Once a bank enters the Unlock Bypass mode, only two write cycles are required
to program a word, instead of four. The “Word Program Command Sequence”
section has details on programming data to the device using both standard and
Unlock Bypass command sequences.
An erase operation can erase one sector, multiple sectors, or the entire device.
Table 4 indicates the set of address space that each sector occupies. A “bank ad-
dress” is the set of address bits required to uniquely select a bank. Similarly, a
“sector address” refers to the address bits required to uniquely select a sector.
The “Command Definitions” section has details on erasing a sector or the entire
chip, or suspending/resuming the erase operation.
ICC2 in the DC Characteristics table represents the active current specification for
the write mode. See the timing specification tables and timing diagrams in the
Reset for write operations.
Accelerated Program Operation
The device offers accelerated program operations through the ACC function. This
function is primarily intended to allow faster manufacturing throughput at the
factory.
If the system asserts VHH on this pin, the device automatically enters the afore-
mentioned Unlock Bypass mode, temporarily unprotects any protected sectors,
and uses the higher voltage on the pin to reduce the time required for program
operations. The system would use a two-cycle program command sequence as
required by the Unlock Bypass mode. Removing VHH from the WP#/ACC pin re-
turns the device to normal operation. Note that VHH must not be asserted on
WP#/ACC for operations other than accelerated programming, or device damage
may result. In addition, the WP#/ACC pin should be raised to VCC when not in
use. That is, the WP#/ACC pin should not be left floating or unconnected; incon-
sistent behavior of the device may result.
Autoselect Functions
If the system writes the autoselect command sequence, the device enters the au-
toselect mode. The system can then read autoselect codes from the internal
register (which is separate from the memory array) on DQ15–DQ0. Standard
read cycle timings apply in this mode. Refer to the SecSiTM Sector Addresses and
Autoselect Command Sequence for more information.
Standby Mode
When the system is not reading or writing to the device, it can place the device
in the standby mode. In this mode, current consumption is greatly reduced, and
the outputs are placed in the high impedance state, independent of the OE#
input.
The device enters the CMOS standby mode when the CE# and RESET# pins are
both held at VIO ± 0.3 V. (Note that this is a more restricted voltage range than
VIH.) If CE# and RESET# are held at VIH, but not within VIO ± 0.3 V, the device
will be in the standby mode, but the standby current will be greater. The device
32 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
requires standard access time (tCE) for read access when the device is in either
of these standby modes, before it is ready to read data.
If the device is deselected during erasure or programming, the device draws ac-
tive current until the operation is completed.
ICC3 in “DC Characteristics” represents the CMOS standby current specification.
Automatic Sleep Mode
The automatic sleep mode minimizes Flash device energy consumption. The de-
vice automatically enables this mode when addresses remain stable for tACC +
30 ns. The automatic sleep mode is independent of the CE#, WE#, and OE# con-
trol signals. Standard address access timings provide new data when addresses
are changed. While in sleep mode, output data is latched and always available to
the system. Note that during automatic sleep mode, OE# must be at VIH before
the device reduces current to the stated sleep mode specification. ICC5 in “DC
Characteristics” represents the automatic sleep mode current specification.
RESET#: Hardware Reset Pin
The RESET# pin provides a hardware method of resetting the device to reading
array data. When the RESET# pin is driven low for at least a period of tRP
, the
device immediately terminates any operation in progress, tristates all output
pins, and ignores all read/write commands for the duration of the RESET# pulse.
The device also resets the internal state machine to reading array data. The op-
eration that was interrupted should be reinitiated once the device is ready to
accept another command sequence, to ensure data integrity.
Current is reduced for the duration of the RESET# pulse. When RESET# is held
at VSS±0.3 V, the device draws CMOS standby current (ICC4). If RESET# is held
at VIL but not within VSS±0.3 V, the standby current will be greater.
The RESET# pin may be tied to the system reset circuitry. A system reset would
thus also reset the Flash memory, enabling the system to read the boot-up firm-
ware from the Flash memory.
If RESET# is asserted during a program or erase operation, the RY/BY# pin re-
mains a “0” (busy) until the internal reset operation is complete, which requires
a time of tREADY (during Embedded Algorithms). The system can thus monitor RY/
BY# to determine whether the reset operation is complete. If RESET# is asserted
when a program or erase operation is not executing (RY/BY# pin is “1”), the reset
operation is completed within a time of tREADY (not during Embedded Algorithms).
The system can read data tRH after the RESET# pin returns to VIH.
Refer to the AC Characteristic tables for RESET# parameters and to 13 for the
timing diagram.
Output Disable Mode
When the OE# input is at VIH, output from the device is disabled. The output pins
(except for RY/BY#) are placed in the highest Impedance state
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 33
Preliminary
Ta bl e 4 . PL127J Sector Architecture
Bank Sector Sector Address (A22-A12) Sector Size (Kwords) Address Range (x16)
Bank A
SA0 00000000000 4000000h–000FFFh
SA1 00000000001 4001000h–001FFFh
SA2 00000000010 4002000h–002FFFh
SA3 00000000011 4003000h–003FFFh
SA4 00000000100 4004000h–004FFFh
SA5 00000000101 4005000h–005FFFh
SA6 00000000110 4006000h–006FFFh
SA7 00000000111 4007000h–007FFFh
SA8 00000001XXX 32 008000h–00FFFFh
SA9 00000010XXX 32 010000h–017FFFh
SA10 00000011XXX 32 018000h–01FFFFh
SA11 00000100XXX 32 020000h–027FFFh
SA12 00000101XXX 32 028000h–02FFFFh
SA13 00000110XXX 32 030000h–037FFFh
SA14 00000111XXX 32 038000h–03FFFFh
SA15 00001000XXX 32 040000h–047FFFh
SA16 00001001XXX 32 048000h–04FFFFh
SA17 00001010XXX 32 050000h–057FFFh
SA18 00001011XXX 32 058000h–05FFFFh
SA19 00001100XXX 32 060000h–067FFFh
SA20 00001101XXX 32 068000h–06FFFFh
SA21 00001110XXX 32 070000h–077FFFh
SA22 00001111XXX 32 078000h–07FFFFh
SA23 00010000XXX 32 080000h–087FFFh
SA24 00010001XXX 32 088000h–08FFFFh
SA25 00010010XXX 32 090000h–097FFFh
SA26 00010011XXX 32 098000h–09FFFFh
SA27 00010100XXX 32 0A0000h–0A7FFFh
SA28 00010101XXX 32 0A8000h–0AFFFFh
SA29 00010110XXX 32 0B0000h–0B7FFFh
SA30 00010111XXX 32 0B8000h–0BFFFFh
SA31 00011000XXX 32 0C0000h–0C7FFFh
SA32 00011001XXX 32 0C8000h–0CFFFFh
SA33 00011010XXX 32 0D0000h–0D7FFFh
SA34 00011011XXX 32 0D8000h–0DFFFFh
SA35 00011100XXX 32 0E0000h–0E7FFFh
SA36 00011101XXX 32 0E8000h–0EFFFFh
SA37 00011110XXX 32 0F0000h–0F7FFFh
SA38 00011111XXX 32 0F8000h–0FFFFFh
34 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
Bank B
SA39 00100000XXX 32 100000h–107FFFh
SA40 00100001XXX 32 108000h–10FFFFh
SA41 00100010XXX 32 110000h–117FFFh
SA42 00100011XXX 32 118000h–11FFFFh
SA43 00100100XXX 32 120000h–127FFFh
SA44 00100101XXX 32 128000h–12FFFFh
SA45 00100110XXX 32 130000h–137FFFh
SA46 00100111XXX 32 138000h–13FFFFh
SA47 00101000XXX 32 140000h–147FFFh
SA48 00101001XXX 32 148000h–14FFFFh
SA49 00101010XXX 32 150000h–157FFFh
SA50 00101011XXX 32 158000h–15FFFFh
SA51 00101100XXX 32 160000h–167FFFh
SA52 00101101XXX 32 168000h–16FFFFh
SA53 00101110XXX 32 170000h–177FFFh
SA54 00101111XXX 32 178000h–17FFFFh
SA55 00110000XXX 32 180000h–187FFFh
SA56 00110001XXX 32 188000h–18FFFFh
SA57 00110010XXX 32 190000h–197FFFh
SA58 00110011XXX 32 198000h–19FFFFh
SA59 00110100XXX 32 1A0000h–1A7FFFh
SA60 00110101XXX 32 1A8000h–1AFFFFh
SA61 00110110XXX 32 1B0000h–1B7FFFh
SA62 00110111XXX 32 1B8000h–1BFFFFh
SA63 00111000XXX 32 1C0000h–1C7FFFh
SA64 00111001XXX 32 1C8000h–1CFFFFh
SA65 00111010XXX 32 1D0000h–1D7FFFh
SA66 00111011XXX 32 1D8000h–1DFFFFh
SA67 00111100XXX 32 1E0000h–1E7FFFh
SA68 00111101XXX 32 1E8000h–1EFFFFh
SA69 00111110XXX 32 1F0000h–1F7FFFh
SA70 00111111XXX 32 1F8000h–1FFFFFh
SA71 01000000XXX 32 200000h–207FFFh
SA72 01000001XXX 32 208000h–20FFFFh
SA73 01000010XXX 32 210000h–217FFFh
SA74 01000011XXX 32 218000h–21FFFFh
SA75 01000100XXX 32 220000h–227FFFh
SA76 01000101XXX 32 228000h–22FFFFh
SA77 01000110XXX 32 230000h–237FFFh
SA78 01000111XXX 32 238000h–23FFFFh
Table 4. PL127J Sector Architecture (Continued)
Bank Sector Sector Address (A22-A12) Sector Size (Kwords) Address Range (x16)
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 35
Preliminary
Bank B
SA79 01001000XXX 32 240000h–247FFFh
SA80 01001001XXX 32 248000h–24FFFFh
SA81 01001010XXX 32 250000h–257FFFh
SA82 01001011XXX 32 258000h–25FFFFh
SA83 01001100XXX 32 260000h–267FFFh
SA84 01001101XXX 32 268000h–26FFFFh
SA85 01001110XXX 32 270000h–277FFFh
SA86 01001111XXX 32 278000h–27FFFFh
SA87 01010000XXX 32 280000h–287FFFh
SA88 01010001XXX 32 288000h–28FFFFh
SA89 01010010XXX 32 290000h–297FFFh
SA90 01010011XXX 32 298000h–29FFFFh
SA91 01010100XXX 32 2A0000h–2A7FFFh
SA92 01010101XXX 32 2A8000h–2AFFFFh
SA93 01010110XXX 32 2B0000h–2B7FFFh
SA94 01010111XXX 32 2B8000h–2BFFFFh
SA95 01011000XXX 32 2C0000h–2C7FFFh
SA96 01011001XXX 32 2C8000h–2CFFFFh
SA97 01011010XXX 32 2D0000h–2D7FFFh
SA98 01011011XXX 32 2D8000h–2DFFFFh
SA99 01011100XXX 32 2E0000h–2E7FFFh
SA100 01011101XXX 32 2E8000h–2EFFFFh
SA101 01011110XXX 32 2F0000h–2F7FFFh
SA102 01011111XXX 32 2F8000h–2FFFFFh
SA103 01100000XXX 32 300000h–307FFFh
SA104 01100001XXX 32 308000h–30FFFFh
SA105 01100010XXX 32 310000h–317FFFh
SA106 01100011XXX 32 318000h–31FFFFh
SA107 01100100XXX 32 320000h–327FFFh
SA108 01100101XXX 32 328000h–32FFFFh
SA109 01100110XXX 32 330000h–337FFFh
SA110 01100111XXX 32 338000h–33FFFFh
SA111 01101000XXX 32 340000h–347FFFh
SA112 01101001XXX 32 348000h–34FFFFh
SA113 01101010XXX 32 350000h–357FFFh
SA114 01101011XXX 32 358000h–35FFFFh
SA115 01101100XXX 32 360000h–367FFFh
SA116 01101101XXX 32 368000h–36FFFFh
SA117 01101110XXX 32 370000h–377FFFh
SA118 01101111XXX 32 378000h–37FFFFh
Table 4. PL127J Sector Architecture (Continued)
Bank Sector Sector Address (A22-A12) Sector Size (Kwords) Address Range (x16)
36 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
Bank B
SA119 01110000XXX 32 380000h–387FFFh
SA120 01110001XXX 32 388000h–38FFFFh
SA121 01110010XXX 32 390000h–397FFFh
SA122 01110011XXX 32 398000h–39FFFFh
SA123 01110100XXX 32 3A0000h–3A7FFFh
SA124 01110101XXX 32 3A8000h–3AFFFFh
SA125 01110110XXX 32 3B0000h–3B7FFFh
SA126 01110111XXX 32 3B8000h–3BFFFFh
SA127 01111000XXX 32 3C0000h–3C7FFFh
SA128 01111001XXX 32 3C8000h–3CFFFFh
SA129 01111010XXX 32 3D0000h–3D7FFFh
SA130 01111011XXX 32 3D8000h–3DFFFFh
SA131 01111100XXX 32 3E0000h–3E7FFFh
SA132 01111101XXX 32 3E8000h–3EFFFFh
SA133 01111110XXX 32 3F0000h–3F7FFFh
SA134 01111111XXX 32 3F8000h–3FFFFFh
Bank C
SA135 10000000XXX 32 400000h–407FFFh
SA136 10000001XXX 32 408000h–40FFFFh
SA137 10000010XXX 32 410000h–417FFFh
SA138 10000011XXX 32 418000h–41FFFFh
SA139 10000100XXX 32 420000h–427FFFh
SA140 10000101XXX 32 428000h–42FFFFh
SA141 10000110XXX 32 430000h–437FFFh
SA142 10000111XXX 32 438000h–43FFFFh
SA143 10001000XXX 32 440000h–447FFFh
SA144 10001001XXX 32 448000h–44FFFFh
SA145 10001010XXX 32 450000h–457FFFh
SA146 10001011XXX 32 458000h–45FFFFh
SA147 10001100XXX 32 460000h–467FFFh
SA148 10001101XXX 32 468000h–46FFFFh
SA149 10001110XXX 32 470000h–477FFFh
SA150 10001111XXX 32 478000h–47FFFFh
SA151 10010000XXX 32 480000h–487FFFh
SA152 10010001XXX 32 488000h–48FFFFh
SA153 10010010XXX 32 490000h–497FFFh
SA154 10010011XXX 32 498000h–49FFFFh
SA155 10010100XXX 32 4A0000h–4A7FFFh
SA156 10010101XXX 32 4A8000h–4AFFFFh
SA157 10010110XXX 32 4B0000h–4B7FFFh
SA158 10010111XXX 32 4B8000h–4BFFFFh
Table 4. PL127J Sector Architecture (Continued)
Bank Sector Sector Address (A22-A12) Sector Size (Kwords) Address Range (x16)
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 37
Preliminary
Bank C
SA159 10011000XXX 32 4C0000h–4C7FFFh
SA160 10011001XXX 32 4C8000h–4CFFFFh
SA161 10011010XXX 32 4D0000h–4D7FFFh
SA162 10011011XXX 32 4D8000h–4DFFFFh
SA163 10011100XXX 32 4E0000h–4E7FFFh
SA164 10011101XXX 32 4E8000h–4EFFFFh
SA165 10011110XXX 32 4F0000h–4F7FFFh
SA166 10011111XXX 32 4F8000h–4FFFFFh
SA167 10100000XXX 32 500000h–507FFFh
SA168 10100001XXX 32 508000h–50FFFFh
SA169 10100010XXX 32 510000h–517FFFh
SA170 10100011XXX 32 518000h–51FFFFh
SA171 10100100XXX 32 520000h–527FFFh
SA172 10100101XXX 32 528000h–52FFFFh
SA173 10100110XXX 32 530000h–537FFFh
SA174 10100111XXX 32 538000h–53FFFFh
SA175 10101000XXX 32 540000h–547FFFh
SA176 10101001XXX 32 548000h–54FFFFh
SA177 10101010XXX 32 550000h–557FFFh
SA178 10101011XXX 32 558000h–15FFFFh
SA179 10101100XXX 32 560000h–567FFFh
SA180 10101101XXX 32 568000h–56FFFFh
SA181 10101110XXX 32 570000h–577FFFh
SA182 10101111XXX 32 578000h–57FFFFh
SA183 10110000XXX 32 580000h–587FFFh
SA184 10110001XXX 32 588000h–58FFFFh
SA185 10110010XXX 32 590000h–597FFFh
SA186 10110011XXX 32 598000h–59FFFFh
SA187 10110100XXX 32 5A0000h–5A7FFFh
SA188 10110101XXX 32 5A8000h–5AFFFFh
SA189 10110110XXX 32 5B0000h–5B7FFFh
SA190 10110111XXX 32 5B8000h–5BFFFFh
SA191 10111000XXX 32 5C0000h–5C7FFFh
SA192 10111001XXX 32 5C8000h–5CFFFFh
SA193 10111010XXX 32 5D0000h–5D7FFFh
SA194 10111011XXX 32 5D8000h–5DFFFFh
SA195 10111100XXX 32 5E0000h–5E7FFFh
SA196 10111101XXX 32 5E8000h–5EFFFFh
SA197 10111110XXX 32 5F0000h–5F7FFFh
SA198 10111111XXX 32 5F8000h–5FFFFFh
Table 4. PL127J Sector Architecture (Continued)
Bank Sector Sector Address (A22-A12) Sector Size (Kwords) Address Range (x16)
38 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
Bank C
SA199 11000000XXX 32 600000h–607FFFh
SA200 11000001XXX 32 608000h–60FFFFh
SA201 11000010XXX 32 610000h–617FFFh
SA202 11000011XXX 32 618000h–61FFFFh
SA203 11000100XXX 32 620000h–627FFFh
SA204 11000101XXX 32 628000h–62FFFFh
SA205 11000110XXX 32 630000h–637FFFh
SA206 11000111XXX 32 638000h–63FFFFh
SA207 11001000XXX 32 640000h–647FFFh
SA208 11001001XXX 32 648000h–64FFFFh
SA209 11001010XXX 32 650000h–657FFFh
SA210 11001011XXX 32 658000h–65FFFFh
SA211 11001100XXX 32 660000h–667FFFh
SA212 11001101XXX 32 668000h–66FFFFh
SA213 11001110XXX 32 670000h–677FFFh
SA214 11001111XXX 32 678000h–67FFFFh
SA215 11010000XXX 32 680000h–687FFFh
SA216 11010001XXX 32 688000h–68FFFFh
SA217 11010010XXX 32 690000h–697FFFh
SA218 11010011XXX 32 698000h–69FFFFh
SA219 11010100XXX 32 6A0000h–6A7FFFh
SA220 11010101XXX 32 6A8000h–6AFFFFh
SA221 11010110XXX 32 6B0000h–6B7FFFh
SA222 11010111XXX 32 6B8000h–6BFFFFh
SA223 11011000XXX 32 6C0000h–6C7FFFh
SA224 11011001XXX 32 6C8000h–6CFFFFh
SA225 11011010XXX 32 6D0000h–6D7FFFh
SA226 11011011XXX 32 6D8000h–6DFFFFh
SA227 11011100XXX 32 6E0000h–6E7FFFh
SA228 11011101XXX 32 6E8000h–6EFFFFh
SA229 11011110XXX 32 6F0000h–6F7FFFh
SA230 11011111XXX 32 6F8000h–6FFFFFh
Table 4. PL127J Sector Architecture (Continued)
Bank Sector Sector Address (A22-A12) Sector Size (Kwords) Address Range (x16)
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 39
Preliminary
Bank D
SA231 11100000XXX 32 700000h–707FFFh
SA232 11100001XXX 32 708000h–70FFFFh
SA233 11100010XXX 32 710000h–717FFFh
SA234 11100011XXX 32 718000h–71FFFFh
SA235 11100100XXX 32 720000h–727FFFh
SA236 11100101XXX 32 728000h–72FFFFh
SA237 11100110XXX 32 730000h–737FFFh
SA238 11100111XXX 32 738000h–73FFFFh
SA239 11101000XXX 32 740000h–747FFFh
SA240 11101001XXX 32 748000h–74FFFFh
SA241 11101010XXX 32 750000h–757FFFh
SA242 11101011XXX 32 758000h–75FFFFh
SA243 11101100XXX 32 760000h–767FFFh
SA244 11101101XXX 32 768000h–76FFFFh
SA245 11101110XXX 32 770000h–777FFFh
SA246 11101111XXX 32 778000h–77FFFFh
SA247 11110000XXX 32 780000h–787FFFh
SA248 11110001XXX 32 788000h–78FFFFh
SA249 11110010XXX 32 790000h–797FFFh
SA250 11110011XXX 32 798000h–79FFFFh
SA251 11110100XXX 32 7A0000h–7A7FFFh
SA252 11110101XXX 32 7A8000h–7AFFFFh
SA253 11110110XXX 32 7B0000h–7B7FFFh
SA254 11110111XXX 32 7B8000h–7BFFFFh
SA255 11111000XXX 32 7C0000h–7C7FFFh
SA256 11111001XXX 32 7C8000h–7CFFFFh
SA257 11111010XXX 32 7D0000h–7D7FFFh
SA258 11111011XXX 32 7D8000h–7DFFFFh
SA259 11111100XXX 32 7E0000h–7E7FFFh
SA260 11111101XXX 32 7E8000h–7EFFFFh
SA261 11111110XXX 32 7F0000h–7F7FFFh
SA262 11111111000 47F8000h–7F8FFFh
SA263 11111111001 47F9000h–7F9FFFh
SA264 11111111010 47FA000h–7FAFFFh
SA265 11111111011 47FB000h–7FBFFFh
SA266 11111111100 47FC000h–7FCFFFh
SA267 11111111101 47FD000h–7FDFFFh
SA268 11111111110 47FE000h–7FEFFFh
SA269 11111111111 47FF000h–7FFFFFh
Table 4. PL127J Sector Architecture (Continued)
Bank Sector Sector Address (A22-A12) Sector Size (Kwords) Address Range (x16)
40 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
Ta b l e 5 . PL064J Sector Architecture
Bank Sector Sector Address (A22-A12) Sector Size (Kwords) Address Range (x16)
Bank A
SA0 0000000000 4000000h–000FFFh
SA1 0000000001 4001000h–001FFFh
SA2 0000000010 4002000h–002FFFh
SA3 0000000011 4003000h–003FFFh
SA4 0000000100 4004000h–004FFFh
SA5 0000000101 4005000h–005FFFh
SA6 0000000110 4006000h–006FFFh
SA7 0000000111 4007000h–007FFFh
SA8 0000001XXX 32 008000h–00FFFFh
SA9 0000010XXX 32 010000h–017FFFh
SA10 0000011XXX 32 018000h–01FFFFh
SA11 0000100XXX 32 020000h–027FFFh
SA12 0000101XXX 32 028000h–02FFFFh
SA13 0000110XXX 32 030000h–037FFFh
SA14 0000111XXX 32 038000h–03FFFFh
SA15 0001000XXX 32 040000h–047FFFh
SA16 0001001XXX 32 048000h–04FFFFh
SA17 0001010XXX 32 050000h–057FFFh
SA18 0001011XXX 32 058000h–05FFFFh
SA19 0001100XXX 32 060000h–067FFFh
SA20 0001101XXX 32 068000h–06FFFFh
SA21 0001110XXX 32 070000h–077FFFh
SA22 0001111XXX 32 078000h–07FFFFh
Bank B
SA23 0010000XXX 32 080000h–087FFFh
SA24 0010001XXX 32 088000h–08FFFFh
SA25 0010010XXX 32 090000h–097FFFh
SA26 0010011XXX 32 098000h–09FFFFh
SA27 0010100XXX 32 0A0000h–0A7FFFh
SA28 0010101XXX 32 0A8000h–0AFFFFh
SA29 0010110XXX 32 0B0000h–0B7FFFh
SA30 0010111XXX 32 0B8000h–0BFFFFh
SA31 0011000XXX 32 0C0000h–0C7FFFh
SA32 0011001XXX 32 0C8000h–0CFFFFh
SA33 0011010XXX 32 0D0000h–0D7FFFh
SA34 0011011XXX 32 0D8000h–0DFFFFh
SA35 0011100XXX 32 0E0000h–0E7FFFh
SA36 0011101XXX 32 0E8000h–0EFFFFh
SA37 0011110XXX 32 0F0000h–0F7FFFh
SA38 0011111XXX 32 0F8000h–0FFFFFh
SA39 0100000XXX 32 100000h–107FFFh
SA40 0100001XXX 32 108000h–10FFFFh
SA41 0100010XXX 32 110000h–117FFFh
SA42 0100011XXX 32 118000h–11FFFFh
SA43 0100100XXX 32 120000h–127FFFh
SA44 0100101XXX 32 128000h–12FFFFh
SA45 0100110XXX 32 130000h–137FFFh
SA46 0100111XXX 32 138000h–13FFFFh
SA47 0101000XXX 32 140000h–147FFFh
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 41
Preliminary
Bank B
SA48 0101001XXX 32 148000h–14FFFFh
SA49 0101010XXX 32 150000h–157FFFh
SA50 0101011XXX 32 158000h–15FFFFh
SA51 0101100XXX 32 160000h–167FFFh
SA52 0101101XXX 32 168000h–16FFFFh
SA53 0101110XXX 32 170000h–177FFFh
SA54 0101111XXX 32 178000h–17FFFFh
SA55 0110000XXX 32 180000h–187FFFh
SA56 0110001XXX 32 188000h–18FFFFh
SA57 0110010XXX 32 190000h–197FFFh
SA58 0110011XXX 32 198000h–19FFFFh
SA59 0110100XXX 32 1A0000h–1A7FFFh
SA60 0110101XXX 32 1A8000h–1AFFFFh
SA61 0110110XXX 32 1B0000h–1B7FFFh
SA62 0110111XXX 32 1B8000h–1BFFFFh
SA63 0111000XXX 32 1C0000h–1C7FFFh
SA64 0111001XXX 32 1C8000h–1CFFFFh
SA65 0111010XXX 32 1D0000h–1D7FFFh
SA66 0111011XXX 32 1D8000h–1DFFFFh
SA67 0111100XXX 32 1E0000h–1E7FFFh
SA68 0111101XXX 32 1E8000h–1EFFFFh
SA69 0111110XXX 32 1F0000h–1F7FFFh
SA70 0111111XXX 32 1F8000h–1FFFFFh
Bank C
SA71 1000000XXX 32 200000h–207FFFh
SA72 1000001XXX 32 208000h–20FFFFh
SA73 1000010XXX 32 210000h–217FFFh
SA74 1000011XXX 32 218000h–21FFFFh
SA75 1000100XXX 32 220000h–227FFFh
SA76 1000101XXX 32 228000h–22FFFFh
SA77 1000110XXX 32 230000h–237FFFh
SA78 1000111XXX 32 238000h–23FFFFh
SA79 1001000XXX 32 240000h–247FFFh
SA80 1001001XXX 32 248000h–24FFFFh
SA81 1001010XXX 32 250000h–257FFFh
SA82 1001011XXX 32 258000h–25FFFFh
SA83 1001100XXX 32 260000h–267FFFh
SA84 1001101XXX 32 268000h–26FFFFh
SA85 1001110XXX 32 270000h–277FFFh
SA86 1001111XXX 32 278000h–27FFFFh
Bank C
SA87 1010000XXX 32 280000h–287FFFh
SA88 1010001XXX 32 288000h–28FFFFh
SA89 1010010XXX 32 290000h–297FFFh
SA90 1010011XXX 32 298000h–29FFFFh
SA91 1010100XXX 32 2A0000h–2A7FFFh
SA92 1010101XXX 32 2A8000h–2AFFFFh
SA93 1010110XXX 32 2B0000h–2B7FFFh
SA94 1010111XXX 32 2B8000h–2BFFFFh
SA95 1011000XXX 32 2C0000h–2C7FFFh
Table 5. PL064J Sector Architecture (Continued)
Bank Sector Sector Address (A22-A12) Sector Size (Kwords) Address Range (x16)
42 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
Bank C
SA96 1011001XXX 32 2C8000h–2CFFFFh
SA97 1011010XXX 32 2D0000h–2D7FFFh
SA98 1011011XXX 32 2D8000h–2DFFFFh
SA99 1011100XXX 32 2E0000h–2E7FFFh
SA100 1011101XXX 32 2E8000h–2EFFFFh
SA101 1011110XXX 32 2F0000h–2F7FFFh
SA102 1011111XXX 32 2F8000h–2FFFFFh
SA103 1100000XXX 32 300000h–307FFFh
SA104 1100001XXX 32 308000h–30FFFFh
SA105 1100010XXX 32 310000h–317FFFh
SA106 1100011XXX 32 318000h–31FFFFh
SA107 1100100XXX 32 320000h–327FFFh
SA108 1100101XXX 32 328000h–32FFFFh
SA109 1100110XXX 32 330000h–337FFFh
SA110 1100111XXX 32 338000h–33FFFFh
SA111 1101000XXX 32 340000h–347FFFh
SA112 1101001XXX 32 348000h–34FFFFh
SA113 1101010XXX 32 350000h–357FFFh
SA114 1101011XXX 32 358000h–35FFFFh
SA115 1101100XXX 32 360000h–367FFFh
SA116 1101101XXX 32 368000h–36FFFFh
SA117 1101110XXX 32 370000h–377FFFh
SA118 1101111XXX 32 378000h–37FFFFh
Bank D
SA119 1110000XXX 32 380000h–387FFFh
SA120 1110001XXX 32 388000h–38FFFFh
SA121 1110010XXX 32 390000h–397FFFh
SA122 1110011XXX 32 398000h–39FFFFh
SA123 1110100XXX 32 3A0000h–3A7FFFh
SA124 1110101XXX 32 3A8000h–3AFFFFh
SA125 1110110XXX 32 3B0000h–3B7FFFh
SA126 1110111XXX 32 3B8000h–3BFFFFh
SA127 1111000XXX 32 3C0000h–3C7FFFh
SA128 1111001XXX 32 3C8000h–3CFFFFh
SA129 1111010XXX 32 3D0000h–3D7FFFh
SA130 1111011XXX 32 3D8000h–3DFFFFh
SA131 1111100XXX 32 3E0000h–3E7FFFh
SA132 1111101XXX 32 3E8000h–3EFFFFh
SA133 1111110XXX 32 3F0000h–3F7FFFh
SA134 1111111000 43F8000h–3F8FFFh
SA135 1111111001 43F9000h–3F9FFFh
SA136 1111111010 43FA000h–3FAFFFh
SA137 1111111011 43FB000h–3FBFFFh
SA138 1111111100 43FC000h–3FCFFFh
SA139 1111111101 43FD000h–3FDFFFh
SA140 1111111110 43FE000h–3FEFFFh
SA141 1111111111 43FF000h–3FFFFFh
Table 5. PL064J Sector Architecture (Continued)
Bank Sector Sector Address (A22-A12) Sector Size (Kwords) Address Range (x16)
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 43
Preliminary
Ta b l e 6 . PL032J Sector Architecture
Bank Sector Sector Address (A22-A12) Sector Size (Kwords) Address Range (x16)
Bank A
SA0 000000000 4000000h–000FFFh
SA1 000000001 4001000h–001FFFh
SA2 000000010 4002000h–002FFFh
SA3 000000011 4003000h–003FFFh
SA4 000000100 4004000h–004FFFh
SA5 000000101 4005000h–005FFFh
SA6 000000110 4006000h–006FFFh
SA7 000000111 4007000h–007FFFh
SA8 000001XXX 32 008000h–00FFFFh
SA9 000010XXX 32 010000h–017FFFh
SA10 000011XXX 32 018000h–01FFFFh
SA11 000100XXX 32 020000h–027FFFh
SA12 000101XXX 32 028000h–02FFFFh
SA13 000110XXX 32 030000h–037FFFh
SA14 000111XXX 32 038000h–03FFFFh
Bank B
SA15 001000XXX 32 040000h–047FFFh
SA16 001001XXX 32 048000h–04FFFFh
SA17 001010XXX 32 050000h–057FFFh
SA18 001011XXX 32 058000h–05FFFFh
SA19 001100XXX 32 060000h–067FFFh
SA20 001101XXX 32 068000h–06FFFFh
SA21 001110XXX 32 070000h–077FFFh
SA22 001111XXX 32 078000h–07FFFFh
SA23 010000XXX 32 080000h–087FFFh
SA24 010001XXX 32 088000h–08FFFFh
SA25 010010XXX 32 090000h–097FFFh
SA26 010011XXX 32 098000h–09FFFFh
SA27 010100XXX 32 0A0000h–0A7FFFh
SA28 010101XXX 32 0A8000h–0AFFFFh
SA29 010110XXX 32 0B0000h–0B7FFFh
SA30 010111XXX 32 0B8000h–0BFFFFh
SA31 011000XXX 32 0C0000h–0C7FFFh
SA32 011001XXX 32 0C8000h–0CFFFFh
SA33 011010XXX 32 0D0000h–0D7FFFh
SA34 011011XXX 32 0D8000h–0DFFFFh
SA35 011100XXX 32 0E0000h–0E7FFFh
SA36 011101XXX 32 0E8000h–0EFFFFh
SA37 011110XXX 32 0F0000h–0F7FFFh
SA38 011111XXX 32 0F8000h–0FFFFFh
44 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
Bank C
SA39 100000XXX 32 100000h–107FFFh
SA40 100001XXX 32 108000h–10FFFFh
SA41 100010XXX 32 110000h–117FFFh
SA42 100011XXX 32 118000h–11FFFFh
SA43 100100XXX 32 120000h–127FFFh
SA44 100101XXX 32 128000h–12FFFFh
SA45 100110XXX 32 130000h–137FFFh
SA46 100111XXX 32 138000h–13FFFFh
SA47 101000XXX 32 140000h–147FFFh
SA48 101001XXX 32 148000h–14FFFFh
SA49 101010XXX 32 150000h–157FFFh
SA50 101011XXX 32 158000h–15FFFFh
SA51 101100XXX 32 160000h–167FFFh
SA52 101101XXX 32 168000h–16FFFFh
SA53 101110XXX 32 170000h–177FFFh
SA54 101111XXX 32 178000h–17FFFFh
SA55 110000XXX 32 180000h–187FFFh
SA56 110001XXX 32 188000h–18FFFFh
SA57 110010XXX 32 190000h–197FFFh
SA58 110011XXX 32 198000h–19FFFFh
SA59 110100XXX 32 1A0000h–1A7FFFh
SA60 110101XXX 32 1A8000h–1AFFFFh
SA61 110110XXX 32 1B0000h–1B7FFFh
SA62 110111XXX 32 1B8000h–1BFFFFh
Bank D
SA63 111000XXX 32 1C0000h–1C7FFFh
SA64 111001XXX 32 1C8000h–1CFFFFh
SA65 111010XXX 32 1D0000h–1D7FFFh
SA66 111011XXX 32 1D8000h–1DFFFFh
SA67 111100XXX 32 1E0000h–1E7FFFh
SA68 111101XXX 32 1E8000h–1EFFFFh
SA69 111110XXX 32 1F0000h–1F7FFFh
SA70 111111000 41F8000h–1F8FFFh
SA71 111111001 41F9000h–1F9FFFh
SA72 111111010 41FA000h–1FAFFFh
SA73 111111011 41FB000h–1FBFFFh
SA74 111111100 41FC000h–1FCFFFh
SA75 111111101 41FD000h–1FDFFFh
SA76 111111110 41FE000h–1FEFFFh
SA77 111111111 41FF000h–1FFFFFh
Ta b l e 7 . SecSiTM Sector Addresses
Sector Size Address Range
Factory-Locked Area 64 words 000000h-00003Fh
Customer-Lockable Area 64 words 000040h-00007Fh
Table 6. PL032J Sector Architecture (Continued)
Bank Sector Sector Address (A22-A12) Sector Size (Kwords) Address Range (x16)
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 45
Preliminary
Autoselect Mode
The autoselect mode provides manufacturer and device identification, and sector
protection verification, through identifier codes output on DQ7–DQ0. This mode
is primarily intended for programming equipment to automatically match a device
to be programmed with its corresponding programming algorithm. However, the
autoselect codes can also be accessed in-system through the command register.
When using programming equipment, the autoselect mode requires VID on ad-
dress pin A9. Address pins must be as shown in Ta b le 8 and Tab le 11. In addition,
when verifying sector protection, the sector address must appear on the appro-
priate highest order address bits (see Ta b l e 3). Ta b l e 8 and Table 11 show the
remaining address bits that are don’t care. When all necessary bits have been set
as required, the programming equipment may then read the corresponding iden-
tifier code on DQ7–DQ0. However, the autoselect codes can also be accessed in-
system through the command register, for instances when the device is erased
or programmed in a system without access to high voltage on the A9 pin. The
command sequence is illustrated in Tabl e 17. Note that if a Bank Address (BA)
(on address bits PL127J: A22A20, PL064J: A21A19, PL032J: A20A18) is as-
serted during the third write cycle of the autoselect command, the host system
can read autoselect data that bank and then immediately read array data from
the other bank, without exiting the autoselect mode.
To access the autoselect codes in-system, the host system can issue the autose-
lect command via the command register, as shown in Table 17. This method does
not require VID. Refer to the Autoselect Command Sequence for more
information.
Legend: L = Logic Low = VIL, H = Logic High = VIH, BA = Bank Address, SA = Sector Address, X = Don’t care.
Note: The autoselect codes may also be accessed in-system via command sequences
Ta b l e 8 . Autoselect Codes (High Voltage Method)
Description CE# OE# WE#
Amax
to
A12
A1
0A9 A8 A7 A6
A5
to
A4
A3 A2 A1 A0 DQ15
to DQ0
Manufacturer ID:
Spansion
products
L L H BA X VID X L L X L L L L 0001h
Device ID
Read
Cycle 1 L
L H BA X VID X L L L
L L L H 227Eh
Read
Cycle 2 L H H H L
2220h (PL127J)
2202h (PL064J)
220Ah (PL032J)
Read
Cycle 3 L H H H H
2200h (PL127J)
2201h (PL064J)
2201h (PL032J)
Sector Protection
Verification L L H SA X VID X L L L L L H L 0001h (protected),
0000h (unprotected)
SecSi Indicator
Bit (DQ7, DQ6) L L H BA X VID X X L X L L H H
00C0h (factory and
customer locked), 0080h
(factory locked)
46 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
Table 9. PL127J Boot Sector/Sector Block Addresses for Protection/Unprotection
Sector A22-A12
Sector/
Sector Block Size Sector A22-A12
Sector/
Sector Block Size
SA0 00000000000 4 Kwords SA131-SA134 011111XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA1 00000000001 4 Kwords SA135-SA138 100000XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA2 00000000010 4 Kwords SA139-SA142 100001XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA3 00000000011 4 Kwords SA143-SA146 100010XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA4 00000000100 4 Kwords SA147-SA150 100011XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA5 00000000101 4 Kwords SA151-SA154 100100XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA6 00000000110 4 Kwords SA155-SA158 100101XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA7 00000000111 4 Kwords SA159-SA162 100110XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA8 00000001XXX 32 Kwords SA163-SA166 100111XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA9 00000010XXX 32 Kwords SA167-SA170 101000XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA10 00000011XXX 32 Kwords SA171-SA174 101001XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA11-SA14 000001XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords SA175-SA178 101010XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA15-SA18 000010XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords SA179-SA182 101011XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA19-SA22 000011XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords SA183-SA186 101100XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA23-SA26 000100XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords SA187-SA190 101101XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA27-SA30 000101XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords SA191-SA194 101110XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA31-SA34 000110XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords SA195-SA198 101111XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA35-SA38 000111XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords SA199-SA202 110000XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA39-SA42 001000XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords SA203-SA206 110001XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA43-SA46 001001XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords SA207-SA210 110010XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA47-SA50 001010XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords SA211-SA214 110011XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA51-SA54 001011XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords SA215-SA218 110100XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA55-SA58 001100XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords SA219-SA222 110101XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA59-SA62 001101XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords SA223-SA226 110110XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA63-SA66 001110XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords SA227-SA230 110111XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA67-SA70 001111XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords SA231-SA234 111000XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA71-SA74 010000XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords SA235-SA238 111001XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA75-SA78 010001XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords SA239-SA242 111010XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA79-SA82 010010XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords SA243-SA246 111011XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA83-SA86 010011XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords SA247-SA250 111100XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA87-SA90 010100XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords SA251-SA254 111101XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA91-SA94 010101XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords SA255-SA258 111110XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA95-SA98 010110XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords SA259 11111100XXX 32 Kwords
SA99-SA102 010111XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords SA260 11111101XXX 32 Kwords
SA103-SA106 011000XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords SA261 11111110XXX 32 Kwords
SA107-SA110 011001XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords SA262 11111111000 4 Kwords
SA111-SA114 011010XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords SA263 11111111001 4 Kwords
SA115-SA118 011011XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords SA264 11111111010 4 Kwords
SA119-SA122 011100XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords SA265 11111111011 4 Kwords
SA123-SA126 011101XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA127-SA130 011110XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 47
Preliminary
Table 10. PL064J Boot Sector/Sector Block Addresses for Protection/Unprotection
Sector A21-A12 Sector/Sector Block Size
SA0 0000000000 4 Kwords
SA1 0000000001 4 Kwords
SA2 0000000010 4 Kwords
SA3 0000000011 4 Kwords
SA4 0000000100 4 Kwords
SA5 0000000101 4 Kwords
SA6 0000000110 4 Kwords
SA7 0000000111 4 Kwords
SA8 0000001XXX 32 Kwords
SA9 0000010XXX 32 Kwords
SA10 0000011XXX 32 Kwords
SA11-SA14 00001XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA15-SA18 00010XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA19-SA22 00011XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA23-SA26 00100XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA27-SA30 00101XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA31-SA34 00110XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA35-SA38 00111XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA39-SA42 01000XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA43-SA46 01001XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA47-SA50 01010XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA51-SA54 01011XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA55-SA58 01100XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA59-SA62 01101XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA63-SA66 01110XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA67-SA70 01111XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA71-SA74 10000XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA75-SA78 10001XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA79-SA82 10010XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA83-SA86 10011XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA87-SA90 10100XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA91-SA94 10101XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA95-SA98 10110XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA99-SA102 10111XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA103-SA106 11000XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA107-SA110 11001XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA111-SA114 11010XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA115-SA118 11011XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA119-SA122 11100XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA123-SA126 11101XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA127-SA130 11110XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA131 1111100XXX 32 Kwords
SA132 1111101XXX 32 Kwords
SA133 1111110XXX 32 Kwords
SA134 1111111000 4 Kwords
SA135 1111111001 4 Kwords
SA136 1111111010 4 Kwords
SA137 1111111011 4 Kwords
SA138 1111111100 4 Kwords
48 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
Selecting a Sector Protection Mode
All parts default to operate in the Persistent Sector Protection mode. The cus-
tomer must then choose if the Persistent or Password Protection method is most
desirable. There are two one-time programmable non-volatile bits that define
which sector protection method will be used. If the Persistent Sector Protection
method is desired, programming the Persistent Sector Protection Mode
Locking Bit permanently sets the device to the Persistent Sector Protection
mode. If the Password Sector Protection method is desired, programming the
SA139 1111111101 4 Kwords
SA140 1111111110 4 Kwords
SA141 1111111111 4 Kwords
Table 11. PL032J Boot Sector/Sector Block Addresses for Protection/Unprotection
Sector A21-A12 Sector/Sector Block Size
SA0 000000000 4 Kwords
SA1 000000001 4 Kwords
SA2 000000010 4 Kwords
SA3 000000011 4 Kwords
SA4 000000100 4 Kwords
SA5 000000101 4 Kwords
SA6 000000110 4 Kwords
SA7 000000111 4 Kwords
SA8 000001XXX 32 Kwords
SA9 000010XXX 32 Kwords
SA10 000011XXX 32 Kwords
SA11-SA14 0001XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA15-SA18 0010XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA19-SA22 0011XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA23-SA26 0100XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA27-SA30 0101XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA31-SA34 0110XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA35-SA38 0111XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA39-SA42 1000XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA43-SA46 1001XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA47-SA50 1010XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA51-SA54 1011XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA55-SA58 1100XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA59-SA62 1101XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA63-SA66 1110XXXXX 128 (4x32) Kwords
SA67 111100XXX 32 Kwords
SA68 111101XXX 32 Kwords
SA69 111110XXX 32 Kwords
SA70 111111000 4 Kwords
SA71 111111001 4 Kwords
SA72 111111010 4 Kwords
SA73 111111011 4 Kwords
SA74 111111100 4 Kwords
SA75 111111101 4 Kwords
SA76 111111110 4 Kwords
SA77 111111111 4 Kwords
Table 10. PL064J Boot Sector/Sector Block Addresses for Protection/Unprotection
Sector A21-A12 Sector/Sector Block Size
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 49
Preliminary
Password Mode Locking Bit permanently sets the device to the Password Sec-
tor Protection mode. It is not possible to switch between the two protection
modes once a locking bit has been set. One of the two modes must be se-
lected when the device is first programmed. This prevents a program or
virus from later setting the Password Mode Locking Bit, which would cause an un-
expected shift from the default Persistent Sector Protection Mode into the
Password Protection Mode.
The device is shipped with all sectors unprotected. Optional Spansion program-
ming services enable programming and protecting sectors at the factory prior to
shipping the device. Contact your local sales office for details.
It is possible to determine whether a sector is protected or unprotected. See the
SecSiTM Sector Addresses for details.
Persistent Sector Protection
The Persistent Sector Protection method replaces the 12 V controlled protection
method in previous Flash devices. This new method provides three different sec-
tor protection states:
Persistently Locked—The sector is protected and cannot be changed.
Dynamically LockedThe sector is protected and can be changed by a simple
command.
Unlocked—The sector is unprotected and can be changed by a simple com-
mand.
To achieve these states, three types of “bits” are used:
Persistent Protection Bit
Persistent Protection Bit Lock
Persistent Sector Protection Mode Locking Bit
Persistent Protection Bit (PPB)
A single Persistent (non-volatile) Protection Bit is assigned to a maximum four
sectors (see the sector address tables for specific sector protection groupings).
All 4 Kword boot-block sectors have individual sector Persistent Protection Bits
(PPBs) for greater flexibility. Each PPB is individually modifiable through the PPB
Write Command.
The device erases all PPBs in parallel. If any PPB requires erasure, the device
must be instructed to preprogram all of the sector PPBs prior to PPB erasure. Oth-
Ta bl e 1 2 . Sector Protection Schemes
DYB PPB PPB Lock Sector State
0 0 0 Unprotected—PPB and DYB are changeable
0 0 1 Unprotected—PPB not changeable, DYB changeable
0 1 0
Protected—PPB and DYB are changeable1 0 0
1 1 0
0 1 1
Protected—PPB not changeable, DYB is changeable1 0 1
1 1 1
50 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
erwise, a previously erased sector PPBs can potentially be over-erased. The Flash
device does not have a built-in means of preventing sector PPBs over-erasure.
Persistent Protection Bit Lock (PPB Lock)
The Persistent Protection Bit Lock (PPB Lock) is a global volatile bit. When set to
“1”, the PPBs cannot be changed. When cleared (“0”), the PPBs are changeable.
There is only one PPB Lock bit per device. The PPB Lock is cleared after power-
up or hardware reset. There is no command sequence to unlock the PPB Lock.
Dynamic Protection Bit (DYB)
A volatile protection bit is assigned for each sector. After power-up or hardware
reset, the contents of all DYBs is “0”. Each DYB is individually modifiable through
the DYB Write Command.
When the parts are first shipped, the PPBs are cleared, the DYBs are cleared, and
PPB Lock is defaulted to power up in the cleared state – meaning the PPBs are
changeable.
When the device is first powered on the DYBs power up cleared (sectors not pro-
tected). The Protection State for each sector is determined by the logical OR of
the PPB and the DYB related to that sector. For the sectors that have the PPBs
cleared, the DYBs control whether or not the sector is protected or unprotected.
By issuing the DYB Write command sequences, the DYBs will be set or cleared,
thus placing each sector in the protected or unprotected state. These are the so-
called Dynamic Locked or Unlocked states. They are called dynamic states be-
cause it is very easy to switch back and forth between the protected and
unprotected conditions. This allows software to easily protect sectors against in-
advertent changes yet does not prevent the easy removal of protection when
changes are needed. The DYBs maybe set or cleared as often as needed.
The PPBs allow for a more static, and difficult to change, level of protection. The
PPBs retain their state across power cycles because they are non-volatile. Indi-
vidual PPBs are set with a command but must all be cleared as a group through
a complex sequence of program and erasing commands. The PPBs are also lim-
ited to 100 erase cycles.
The PPB Lock bit adds an additional level of protection. Once all PPBs are pro-
grammed to the desired settings, the PPB Lock may be set to “1”. Setting the PPB
Lock disables all program and erase commands to the non-volatile PPBs. In ef-
fect, the PPB Lock Bit locks the PPBs into their current state. The only way to clear
the PPB Lock is to go through a power cycle. System boot code can determine if
any changes to the PPB are needed; for example, to allow new system code to
be downloaded. If no changes are needed then the boot code can set the PPB
Lock to disable any further changes to the PPBs during system operation.
The WP#/ACC write protect pin adds a final level of hardware protection to sec-
tors SA1-133, SA1-134, SA2-0 and SA2-1. When this pin is low it is not possible
to change the contents of these sectors. These sectors generally hold system
boot code. The WP#/ACC pin can prevent any changes to the boot code that could
override the choices made while setting up sector protection during system
initialization.
For customers who are concerned about malicious viruses there is another level
of security - the persistently locked state. To persistently protect a given sector
or sector group, the PPBs associated with that sector need to be set to “1”. Once
all PPBs are programmed to the desired settings, the PPB Lock should be set to
“1”. Setting the PPB Lock automatically disables all program and erase commands
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 51
Preliminary
to the Non-Volatile PPBs. In effect, the PPB Lock “freezes” the PPBs into their cur-
rent state. The only way to clear the PPB Lock is to go through a power cycle.
It is possible to have sectors that have been persistently locked, and sectors that
are left in the dynamic state. The sectors in the dynamic state are all unprotected.
If there is a need to protect some of them, a simple DYB Write command se-
quence is all that is necessary. The DYB write command for the dynamic sectors
switch the DYBs to signify protected and unprotected, respectively. If there is a
need to change the status of the persistently locked sectors, a few more steps
are required. First, the PPB Lock bit must be disabled by either putting the device
through a power-cycle, or hardware reset. The PPBs can then be changed to re-
flect the desired settings. Setting the PPB lock bit once again will lock the PPBs,
and the device operates normally again.
The best protection is achieved by executing the PPB lock bit set command early
in the boot code, and protect the boot code by holding WP#/ACC = VIL.
Table 17 contains all possible combinations of the DYB, PPB, and PPB lock relating
to the status of the sector.
In summary, if the PPB is set, and the PPB lock is set, the sector is protected and
the protection can not be removed until the next power cycle clears the PPB lock.
If the PPB is cleared, the sector can be dynamically locked or unlocked. The DYB
then controls whether or not the sector is protected or unprotected.
If the user attempts to program or erase a protected sector, the device ignores
the command and returns to read mode. A program command to a protected sec-
tor enables status polling for approximately 1 µs before the device returns to read
mode without having modified the contents of the protected sector. An erase
command to a protected sector enables status polling for approximately 50 µs
after which the device returns to read mode without having erased the protected
sector.
The programming of the DYB, PPB, and PPB lock for a given sector can be verified
by writing a DYB/PPB/PPB lock verify command to the device. There is an alter-
native means of reading the protection status. Take RESET# to VIL and hold WE#
at VIH.(The high voltage A9 Autoselect Mode also works for reading the status of
the PPBs). Scanning the addresses (A18–A11) while (A6, A1, A0) = (0, 1, 0) will
produce a logical ‘1” code at device output DQ0 for a protected sector or a “0” for
an unprotected sector. In this mode, the other addresses are don’t cares. Address
location with A1 = VIL are reserved for autoselect manufacturer and device
codes.
Persistent Sector Protection Mode Locking Bit
Like the password mode locking bit, a Persistent Sector Protection mode locking
bit exists to guarantee that the device remain in software sector protection. Once
set, the Persistent Sector Protection locking bit prevents programming of the
password protection mode locking bit. This guarantees that a hacker could not
place the device in password protection mode.
Password Protection Mode
The Password Sector Protection Mode method allows an even higher level of se-
curity than the Persistent Sector Protection Mode. There are two main differences
between the Persistent Sector Protection and the Password Sector Protection
Mode:
52 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
When the device is first powered on, or comes out of a reset cycle, the PPB Lock
bit set to the locked state, rather than cleared to the unlocked state.
The only means to clear the PPB Lock bit is by writing a unique 64-bit Password
to the device.
The Password Sector Protection method is otherwise identical to the Persistent
Sector Protection method.
A 64-bit password is the only additional tool utilized in this method.
Once the Password Mode Locking Bit is set, the password is permanently set with
no means to read, program, or erase it. The password is used to clear the PPB
Lock bit. The Password Unlock command must be written to the Flash, along with
a password. The Flash device internally compares the given password with the
pre-programmed password. If they match, the PPB Lock bit is cleared, and the
PPBs can be altered. If they do not match, the Flash device does nothing. There
is a built-in 2 µs delay for each “password check.” This delay is intended to thwart
any efforts to run a program that tries all possible combinations in order to crack
the password.
Password and Password Mode Locking Bit
In order to select the Password sector protection scheme, the customer must first
program the password. The password may be correlated to the unique Electronic
Serial Number (ESN) of the particular Flash device. Each ESN is different for
every Flash device; therefore each password should be different for every Flash
device. While programming in the password region, the customer may perform
Password Verify operations.
Once the desired password is programmed in, the customer must then set the
Password Mode Locking Bit. This operation achieves two objectives:
Permanently sets the device to operate using the Password Protection Mode. It is
not possible to reverse this function.
Disables all further commands to the password region. All program, and read op-
erations are ignored.
Both of these objectives are important, and if not carefully considered, may lead
to unrecoverable errors. The user must be sure that the Password Protection
method is desired when setting the Password Mode Locking Bit. More importantly,
the user must be sure that the password is correct when the Password Mode
Locking Bit is set. Due to the fact that read operations are disabled, there is no
means to verify what the password is afterwards. If the password is lost after set-
ting the Password Mode Locking Bit, there will be no way to clear the PPB Lock bit.
The Password Mode Locking Bit, once set, prevents reading the 64-bit password
on the DQ bus and further password programming. The Password Mode Locking
Bit is not erasable. Once Password Mode Locking Bit is programmed, the Persis-
tent Sector Protection Locking Bit is disabled from programming, guaranteeing
that no changes to the protection scheme are allowed.
64-bit Password
The 64-bit Password is located in its own memory space and is accessible through
the use of the Password Program and Verify commands (see “Password Verify
Command”). The password function works in conjunction with the Password
Mode Locking Bit, which when set, prevents the Password Verify command from
reading the contents of the password on the pins of the device.
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 53
Preliminary
Write Protect (WP#)
The Write Protect feature provides a hardware method of protecting the upper
two and lower two sectors(PL127J: 0, 1, 268, and 269, PL064J: 0, 1, 140, and
141, PL032J: 0, 1, 76, and 77, PL129J: SA1-133, SA1-134,SA2-0 and SA2-1)
without using VID. This function is provided by the WP# pin and overrides the pre-
viously discussed High Voltage Sector Protection method.
If the system asserts VIL on the WP#/ACC pin, the device disables program and
erase functions in the two outermost 4 Kword sectors on both ends of the Flash
array independent of whether it was previously protected or unprotected.
If the system asserts VIH on the WP#/ACC pin, the device reverts the upper two
and lower two sectors to whether they were last set to be protected or unpro-
tected. That is, sector protection or unprotection for these sectors depends on
whether they were last protected or unprotected using the method described in
the High Voltage Sector Protection.
Note that the WP#/ACC pin must not be left floating or unconnected; inconsistent
behavior of the device may result.
Persistent Protection Bit Lock
The Persistent Protection Bit (PPB) Lock is a volatile bit that reflects the state of
the Password Mode Locking Bit after power-up reset. If the Password Mode Lock
Bit is also set after a hardware reset (RESET# asserted) or a power-up reset, the
ONLY means for clearing the PPB Lock Bit in Password Protection Mode is to issue
the Password Unlock command. Successful execution of the Password Unlock
command clears the PPB Lock Bit, allowing for sector PPBs modifications. Assert-
ing RESET#, taking the device through a power-on reset, or issuing the PPB Lock
Bit Set command sets the PPB Lock Bit to a “1” when the Password Mode Lock Bit
is not set.
If the Password Mode Locking Bit is not set, including Persistent Protection Mode,
the PPB Lock Bit is cleared after power-up or hardware reset. The PPB Lock Bit is
set by issuing the PPB Lock Bit Set command. Once set the only means for clear-
ing the PPB Lock Bit is by issuing a hardware or power-up reset. The Password
Unlock command is ignored in Persistent Protection Mode.
High Voltage Sector Protection
Sector protection and unprotection may also be implemented using programming
equipment. The procedure requires high voltage (VID) to be placed on the RE-
SET# pin. Refer to Figure 1 for details on this procedure. Note that for sector
unprotect, all unprotected sectors must first be protected prior to the first sector
write cycle.
54 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
Figure 1. In-System Sector Protection/Sector Unprotection Algorithms
Sector Protect:
Write 60h to sector
address with
A7-A0 =
00000010
Set up sector
address
Wait 100 µs
Verify Sector
Protect: Write 40h
to sector address
with A7-A0 =
00000010
Read from
sector address
with A7-A0 =
00000010
START
PLSCNT = 1
RESET# = V
ID
Wait 4 µs
First Write
Cycle = 60h?
Data = 01h?
Remove V
ID
from RESET#
Write reset
command
Sector Protect
complete
Yes
Yes
No
PLSCNT
= 25?
Yes
Device failed
Increment
PLSCNT
Temporary Sector
Unprotect Mode No
Sector Unprotect:
Write 60h to sector
address with
A7-A0 =
01000010
Set up first sector
address
Wait 1.2 ms
Verify Sector
Unprotect: Write
40h to sector
address with
A7-A0 =
00000010
Read from
sector address
with A7-A0 =
00000010
START
PLSCNT = 1
RESET# = V
ID
Wait 4 µs
Data = 00h?
Last sector
verified?
Remove V
ID
from RESET#
Write reset
command
Sector Unprotect
complete
Yes
No
PLSCNT
= 1000?
Yes
Device failed
Increment
PLSCNT
Temporary Secto
r
Unprotect Mode
No All sectors
protected?
Yes
Protect all sectors:
The indicated portion
of the sector protect
algorithm must be
performed for all
unprotected sectors
prior to issuing the
first sector
unprotect address
Set up
next sector
address
No
Yes
No
Yes
No
No
Yes
No
Sector Protect
Algorithm
Sector Unprotect
Algorithm
First Write
Cycle = 60h?
Protect another
sector?
Reset
PLSCNT = 1
Remove V
ID
from RESET#
Write reset
command
Sector Protect
complete
Remove V
ID
from RESET#
Write reset
command
Sector Unprotect
complete
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 55
Preliminary
Temporary Sector Unprotect
This feature allows temporary unprotection of previously protected sectors to
change data in-system. The Sector Unprotect mode is activated by setting the
RESET# pin to VID. During this mode, formerly protected sectors can be pro-
grammed or erased by selecting the sector addresses. Once VID is removed from
the RESET# pin, all the previously protected sectors are protected again. 2 shows
the algorithm, and 21 shows the timing diagrams, for this feature. While PPB lock
is set, the device cannot enter the Temporary Sector Unprotection Mode.
SecSi™ (Secured Silicon) Sector Flash Memory Region
The SecSi (Secured Silicon) Sector feature provides a Flash memory region that
enables permanent part identification through an Electronic Serial Number (ESN)
The 128-word SecSi sector is divided into 64 factory-lockable words that can be
programmed and locked by the customer. The SecSi sector is located at ad-
dresses 000000h-00007Fh in both Persistent Protection mode and Password
Protection mode. It uses indicator bits (DQ6, DQ7) to indicate the factory-locked
and customer-locked status of the part.
The system accesses the SecSi Sector through a command sequence (see the
Enter SecSi™ Sector/Exit SecSi Sector Command Sequence). After the system
has written the Enter SecSi Sector command sequence, it may read the SecSi
Sector by using the addresses normally occupied by the boot sectors. This mode
of operation continues until the system issues the Exit SecSi Sector command se-
quence, or until power is removed from the device. On power-up, or following a
hardware reset, the device reverts to sending commands to the normal address
space. Note that the ACC function and unlock bypass modes are not available
when the SecSi Sector is enabled.
Factory-Locked Area (64 words)
The factory-locked area of the SecSi Sector (000000h-00003Fh) is locked when
the part is shipped, whether or not the area was programmed at the factory. The
Notes:
1. All protected sectors unprotected (If WP#/ACC = VIL, upper two and lower two
sectors will remain protected).
2. All previously protected sectors are protected once again
Figure 2. Temporary Sector Unprotect Operation
START
Perform Erase or
Program Operations
RESET# = VIH
Temp ora ry S ect o r
Unprotect Completed
(Note 2)
RESET# = VID
(Note 1)
56 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
SecSi Sector Factory-locked Indicator Bit (DQ7) is permanently set to a “1”. Op-
tional Spansion programming services can program the factory-locked area with
a random ESN, a customer-defined code, or any combination of the two. Because
only FASL can program and protect the factory-locked area, this method ensures
the security of the ESN once the product is shipped to the field. Contact your local
sales office for details on using Spansion’s programming services. Note that the
ACC function and unlock bypass modes are not available when the SecSi sector
is enabled.
Customer-Lockable Area (64 words)
The customer-lockable area of the SecSi Sector (000040h-00007Fh) is shipped
unprotected, which allows the customer to program and optionally lock the area
as appropriate for the application. The SecSi Sector Customer-locked Indicator
Bit (DQ6) is shipped as “0” and can be permanently locked to “1” by issuing the
SecSi Protection Bit Program Command. The SecSi Sector can be read any num-
ber of times, but can be programmed and locked only once. Note that the
accelerated programming (ACC) and unlock bypass functions are not available
when programming the SecSi Sector.
The Customer-lockable SecSi Sector area can be protected using one of the
following procedures:
Write the three-cycle Enter SecSi Sector Region command sequence, and
then follow the in-system sector protect algorithm as shown in Figure 1, ex-
cept that RESET# may be at either VIH or VID. This allows in-system protec-
tion of the SecSi Sector Region without raising any device pin to a high
voltage. Note that this method is only applicable to the SecSi Sector.
To verify the protect/unprotect status of the SecSi Sector, follow the algo-
rithm shown in Figure 3.
Once the SecSi Sector is locked and verified, the system must write the Exit SecSi
Sector Region command sequence to return to reading and writing the remainder
of the array.
The SecSi Sector lock must be used with caution since, once locked, there is no
procedure available for unlocking the SecSi Sector area and none of the bits in
the SecSi Sector memory space can be modified in any way.
SecSi Sector Protection Bits
The SecSi Sector Protection Bits prevent programming of the SecSi Sector mem-
ory area. Once set, the SecSi Sector memory area contents are non-modifiable.
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 57
Preliminary
Hardware Data Protection
The command sequence requirement of unlock cycles for programming or erasing
provides data protection against inadvertent writes. In addition, the following
hardware data protection measures prevent accidental erasure or programming,
which might otherwise be caused by spurious system level signals during VCC
power-up and power-down transitions, or from system noise.
Low VCC Write Inhibit
When VCC is less than VLKO, the device does not accept any write cycles. This pro-
tects data during VCC power-up and power-down. The command register and all
internal program/erase circuits are disabled, and the device resets to the read
mode. Subsequent writes are ignored until VCC is greater than VLKO. The system
must provide the proper signals to the control pins to prevent unintentional writes
when VCC is greater than VLKO.
Write Pulse “Glitch” Protection
Noise pulses of less than 3 ns (typical) on OE#, CE#, or WE# do not initiate a
write cycle.
Logical Inhibit
Write cycles are inhibited by holding any one of OE# = VIL, CE# = VIH or WE# =
VIH. To initiate a write cycle, CE# and WE# must be a logical zero while OE# is a
logical one.
Power-Up Write Inhibit
If WE# = CE# = VIL and OE# = VIH during power up, the device does not accept
commands on the rising edge of WE#. The internal state machine is automatically
reset to the read mode on power-up.
Figure 3. SecSi Sector Protect Verify
Write 60h to
any address
Write 40h to SecSi
Sector address
with A6 = 0,
A1 = 1, A0 = 0
START
RESET# =
VIH or VID
Wait 1 µs
Read from SecSi
Sector address
with A6 = 0,
A1 = 1, A0 = 0
If data = 00h,
SecSi Sector is
unprotected.
If data = 01h,
SecSi Sector is
protected.
Remove VIH or VID
from RESET#
Write reset
command
SecSi Sector
Protect Verify
complete
58 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
Common Flash Memory Interface (CFI)
The Common Flash Interface (CFI) specification outlines device and host system
software interrogation handshake, which allows specific vendor-specified soft-
ware algorithms to be used for entire families of devices. Software support can
then be device-independent, JEDEC ID-independent, and forward- and back-
ward-compatible for the specified Flash device families. Flash vendors can
standardize their existing interfaces for long-term compatibility.
This device enters the CFI Query mode when the system writes the CFI Query
command, 98h, to address 55h, any time the device is ready to read array data.
The system can read CFI information at the addresses given in Tables 1316. To
terminate reading CFI data, the system must write the reset command. The CFI
Query mode is not accessible when the device is executing an Embedded Program
or embedded Erase algorithm.
The system can also write the CFI query command when the device is in the au-
toselect mode. The device enters the CFI query mode, and the system can read
CFI data at the addresses given in Tables 1316. The system must write the reset
command to return the device to reading array data.
For further information, please refer to the CFI Specification and CFI Publication
100. Contact your local sales office for copies of these documents.
Table 13. CFI Query Identification String
Addresses Data Description
10h
11h
12h
0051h
0052h
0059h
Query Unique ASCII string “QRY”
13h
14h
0002h
0000h Primary OEM Command Set
15h
16h
0040h
0000h Address for Primary Extended Table
17h
18h
0000h
0000h Alternate OEM Command Set (00h = none exists)
19h
1Ah
0000h
0000h Address for Alternate OEM Extended Table (00h = none exists)
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 59
Preliminary
Table 14. System Interface String
Addresses Data Description
1Bh 0027h V
CC
Min. (write/erase)
D7–D4: volt, D3–D0: 100 millivolt
1Ch 0036h V
CC
Max. (write/erase)
D7–D4: volt, D3–D0: 100 millivolt
1Dh 0000h V
PP
Min. voltage (00h = no V
PP
pin present)
1Eh 0000h V
PP
Max. voltage (00h = no V
PP
pin present)
1Fh 0003h Typical timeout per single byte/word write 2
N
µs
20h 0000h Typical timeout for Min. size buffer write 2
N
µ
s (00h = not supported)
21h 0009h Typical timeout per individual block erase 2
N
ms
22h 0000h Typical timeout for full chip erase 2
N
ms (00h = not supported)
23h 0004h Max. timeout for byte/word write 2
N
times typical
24h 0000h Max. timeout for buffer write 2
N
times typical
25h 0004h Max. timeout per individual block erase 2
N
times typical
26h 0000h Max. timeout for full chip erase 2
N
times typical (00h = not supported)
Table 15. Device Geometry Definition
Addresses Data Description
27h
0018h (PL127J)
0017h (PL064J)
0016h (PL032J)
Device Size = 2
N
byte
28h
29h
0001h
0000h Flash Device Interface description (refer to CFI publication 100)
2Ah
2Bh
0000h
0000h
Max. number of byte in multi-byte write = 2
N
(00h = not supported)
2Ch 0003h Number of Erase Block Regions within device
2Dh
2Eh
2Fh
30h
0007h
0000h
0020h
0000h
Erase Block Region 1 Information
(refer to the CFI specification or CFI publication 100)
31h
00FDh (PL127J)
007Dh (PL064J)
003Dh (PL032J) Erase Block Region 2 Information
(refer to the CFI specification or CFI publication 100)
32h
33h
34h
0000h
0000h
0001h
35h
36h
37h
38h
0007h
0000h
0020h
0000h
Erase Block Region 3 Information
(refer to the CFI specification or CFI publication 100)
39h
3Ah
3Bh
3Ch
0000h
0000h
0000h
0000h
Erase Block Region 4 Information
(refer to the CFI specification or CFI publication 100)
60 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
Table 16. Primary Vendor-Specific Extended Query
Addresses Data Description
40h
41h
42h
0050h
0052h
0049h
Query-unique ASCII stringPRI”
43h 0031h Major version number, ASCII (reflects modifications to the silicon)
44h 0033h Minor version number, ASCII (reflects modifications to the CFI table)
45h
TBD
Address Sensitive Unlock (Bits 1-0)
0 = Required, 1 = Not Required
Silicon Revision Number (Bits 7-2)
46h 0002h Erase Suspend
0 = Not Supported, 1 = To Read Only, 2 = To Read & Write
47h 0001h Sector Protect
0 = Not Supported, X = Number of sectors in per group
48h 0001h Sector Temporary Unprotect
00 = Not Supported, 01 = Supported
49h 0007h (PLxxxJ) Sector Protect/Unprotect scheme
07 = Advanced Sector Protection
4Ah
00E7h (PL127J)
0077h (PL064J)
003Fh (PL032J)
Simultaneous Operation
00 = Not Supported, X = Number of Sectors excluding Bank 1
4Bh 0000h Burst Mode Type
00 = Not Supported, 01 = Supported
4Ch 0002h (PLxxxJ) Page Mode Type
00 = Not Supported, 01 = 4 Word Page, 02 = 8 Word Page
4Dh 0085h ACC (Acceleration) Supply Minimum
00h = Not Supported, D7-D4: Volt, D3-D0: 100 mV
4Eh 0095h ACC (Acceleration) Supply Maximum
00h = Not Supported, D7-D4: Volt, D3-D0: 100 mV
4Fh 0001h
Top/Bottom Boot Sector Flag
00h = Uniform device, 01h = Both top and bottom boot with write protect,
02h = Bottom Boot Device, 03h = Top Boot Device,
04h = Both Top and Bottom
50h 0001h Program Suspend
0 = Not supported, 1 = Supported
57h 0004h Bank Organization
00 = Data at 4Ah is zero, X = Number of Banks
58h
0027h (PL127J)
0017h (PL064J)
000Fh (PL032J)
Bank 1 Region Information
X = Number of Sectors in Bank 1
59h
0060h (PL127J)
0030h (PL064J)
0018h (PL032J)
Bank 2 Region Information
X = Number of Sectors in Bank 2
5Ah
0060h (PL127J)
0030h (PL064J)
0018h (PL032J)
Bank 3 Region Information
X = Number of Sectors in Bank 3
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 61
Preliminary
5Bh
0027h (PL127J)
0017h (PL064J)
000Fh (PL032J)
Bank 4 Region Information
X = Number of Sectors in Bank 4
Table 16. Primary Vendor-Specific Extended Query (Continued)
Addresses Data Description
62 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
Command Definitions
Writing specific address and data commands or sequences into the command
register initiates device operations. Tabl e 17 defines the valid register command
sequences. Writing incorrect address and data values or writing them in the
improper sequence may place the device in an unknown state. A reset com-
mand is then required to return the device to reading array data.
All addresses are latched on the falling edge of WE# or CE#, whichever happens
later. All data is latched on the rising edge of WE# or CE#, whichever happens
first. Refer to the AC Characteristic section for timing diagrams.
Reading Array Data
The device is automatically set to reading array data after device power-up. No
commands are required to retrieve data. Each bank is ready to read array data
after completing an Embedded Program or Embedded Erase algorithm.
After the device accepts an Erase Suspend command, the corresponding bank
enters the erase-suspend-read mode, after which the system can read data from
any non-erase-suspended sector within the same bank. The system can read
array data using the standard read timing, except that if it reads at an address
within erase-suspended sectors, the device outputs status data. After completing
a programming operation in the Erase Suspend mode, the system may once
again read array data with the same exception. See the Erase Suspend/Erase Re-
sume Commands section for more information.
The system must issue the reset command to return a bank to the read (or erase-
suspend-read) mode if DQ5 goes high during an active program or erase opera-
tion, or if the bank is in the autoselect mode. See the next section, Reset
Command, for more information.
See also Requirements for Reading Array Data in the Device Bus Operations sec-
tion for more information. The AC Characteristic table provides the read
parameters, and Figure 12 shows the timing diagram.
Reset Command
Writing the reset command resets the banks to the read or erase-suspend-read
mode. Address bits are don’t cares for this command.
The reset command may be written between the sequence cycles in an erase
command sequence before erasing begins. This resets the bank to which the sys-
tem was writing to the read mode. Once erasure begins, however, the device
ignores reset commands until the operation is complete.
The reset command may be written between the sequence cycles in a program
command sequence before programming begins. This resets the bank to which
the system was writing to the read mode. If the program command sequence is
written to a bank that is in the Erase Suspend mode, writing the reset command
returns that bank to the erase-suspend-read mode. Once programming begins,
however, the device ignores reset commands until the operation is complete.
The reset command may be written between the sequence cycles in an autoselect
command sequence. Once in the autoselect mode, the reset command must be
written to return to the read mode. If a bank entered the autoselect mode while
in the Erase Suspend mode, writing the reset command returns that bank to the
erase-suspend-read mode.
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 63
Preliminary
If DQ5 goes high during a program or erase operation, writing the reset command
returns the banks to the read mode (or erase-suspend-read mode if that bank
was in Erase Suspend).
Autoselect Command Sequence
The autoselect command sequence allows the host system to access the manu-
facturer and device codes, and determine whether or not a sector is protected.
The autoselect command sequence may be written to an address within a bank
that is either in the read or erase-suspend-read mode. The autoselect command
may not be written while the device is actively programming or erasing in the
other bank.
The autoselect command sequence is initiated by first writing two unlock cycles.
This is followed by a third write cycle that contains the bank address and the au-
toselect command. The bank then enters the autoselect mode. The system may
read any number of autoselect codes without reinitiating the command sequence.
Ta ble 17 shows the address and data requirements. To determine sector protec-
tion information, the system must write to the appropriate bank address (BA) and
sector address (SA). Tab l e 3 shows the address range and bank number associ-
ated with each sector.
The system must write the reset command to return to the read mode (or erase-
suspend-read mode if the bank was previously in Erase Suspend).
Enter SecSi™ Sector/Exit SecSi Sector Command Sequence
The SecSi Sector region provides a secured data area containing a random, eight
word electronic serial number (ESN). The system can access the SecSi Sector re-
gion by issuing the three-cycle Enter SecSi Sector command sequence. The
device continues to access the SecSi Sector region until the system issues the
four-cycle Exit SecSi Sector command sequence. The Exit SecSi Sector command
sequence returns the device to normal operation. The SecSi Sector is not acces-
sible when the device is executing an Embedded Program or embedded Erase
algorithm. Ta ble 17 shows the address and data requirements for both command
sequences. See also “SecSi™ (Secured Silicon) Sector Flash Memory Region for
further information. Note that the ACC function and unlock bypass modes are not
available when the SecSi Sector is enabled.
Word Program Command Sequence
Programming is a four-bus-cycle operation. The program command sequence is
initiated by writing two unlock write cycles, followed by the program set-up com-
mand. The program address and data are written next, which in turn initiate the
Embedded Program algorithm. The system is not required to provide further con-
trols or timings. The device automatically provides internally generated program
pulses and verifies the programmed cell margin. Tab l e 17 shows the address and
data requirements for the program command sequence. Note that the SecSi Sec-
tor, autoselect, and CFI functions are unavailable when a [program/erase]
operation is in progress.
When the Embedded Program algorithm is complete, that bank then returns to
the read mode and addresses are no longer latched. The system can determine
the status of the program operation by using DQ7, DQ6, or RY/BY#. Refer to the
Write Operation Status section for information on these status bits.
Any commands written to the device during the Embedded Program Algorithm
are ignored. Note that a hardware reset immediately terminates the program
64 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
operation. The program command sequence should be reinitiated once that bank
has returned to the read mode, to ensure data integrity. Note that the SecSi Sec-
tor, autoselect and CFI functions are unavailable when the SecSi Sector is
enabled.
Programming is allowed in any sequence and across sector boundaries. A bit
cannot be programmed from “0” back to a “1.” Attempting to do so may
cause that bank to set DQ5 = 1, or cause the DQ7 and DQ6 status bits to indicate
the operation was successful. However, a succeeding read will show that the data
is still “0.” Only erase operations can convert a “0” to a “1.
Unlock Bypass Command Sequence
The unlock bypass feature allows the system to program data to a bank faster
than using the standard program command sequence. The unlock bypass com-
mand sequence is initiated by first writing two unlock cycles. This is followed by
a third write cycle containing the unlock bypass command, 20h. That bank then
enters the unlock bypass mode. A two-cycle unlock bypass program command
sequence is all that is required to program in this mode. The first cycle in this se-
quence contains the unlock bypass program command, A0h; the second cycle
contains the program address and data. Additional data is programmed in the
same manner. This mode dispenses with the initial two unlock cycles required in
the standard program command sequence, resulting in faster total programming
time. Tab l e 17 shows the requirements for the command sequence.
During the unlock bypass mode, only the Unlock Bypass Program and Unlock By-
pass Reset commands are valid. To exit the unlock bypass mode, the system
must issue the two-cycle unlock bypass reset command sequence. (See Table 18)
The device offers accelerated program operations through the WP#/ACC pin.
When the system asserts VHH on the WP#/ACC pin, the device automatically en-
ters the Unlock Bypass mode. The system may then write the two-cycle Unlock
Bypass program command sequence. The device uses the higher voltage on the
WP#/ACC pin to accelerate the operation. Note that the WP#/ACC pin must not
be at VHH any operation other than accelerated programming, or device damage
may result. In addition, the WP#/ACC pin must not be left floating or uncon-
nected; inconsistent behavior of the device may result.
4 illustrates the algorithm for the program operation. Refer to the Erase/Program
Operations table in the AC Characteristics section for parameters, and Figure 14
for timing diagrams.
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 65
Preliminary
Chip Erase Command Sequence
Chip erase is a six bus cycle operation. The chip erase command sequence is ini-
tiated by writing two unlock cycles, followed by a set-up command. Two
additional unlock write cycles are then followed by the chip erase command,
which in turn invokes the Embedded Erase algorithm. The device does not require
the system to preprogram prior to erase. The Embedded Erase algorithm auto-
matically preprograms and verifies the entire memory for an all zero data pattern
prior to electrical erase. The system is not required to provide any controls or tim-
ings during these operations. Ta b l e 17 shows the address and data requirements
for the chip erase command sequence.
When the Embedded Erase algorithm is complete, that bank returns to the read
mode and addresses are no longer latched. The system can determine the status
of the erase operation by using DQ7, DQ6, DQ2, or RY/BY#. Refer to the Write
Operation Status section for information on these status bits.
Any commands written during the chip erase operation are ignored. Note that
SecSi Sector, autoselect, and CFI functions are unavailable when a [program/
erase] operation is in progress. However, note that a hardware reset immedi-
ately terminates the erase operation. If that occurs, the chip erase command
sequence should be reinitiated once that bank has returned to reading array data,
to ensure data integrity.
Note: See Table 17 for program command sequence.
Figure 4. Program Operation
START
Write Program
Command Sequence
Data Poll
from System
Verify Data? No
Yes
Last Address?
No
Yes
Programming
Completed
Increment Address
Embedded
Program
algorithm
in progress
66 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
5 illustrates the algorithm for the erase operation. Refer to the Erase/Program
Operations tables in the AC Characteristics section for parameters, and Figure 16
section for timing diagrams.
Sector Erase Command Sequence
Sector erase is a six bus cycle operation. The sector erase command sequence is
initiated by writing two unlock cycles, followed by a set-up command. Two addi-
tional unlock cycles are written, and are then followed by the address of the
sector to be erased, and the sector erase command. Table 17 shows the address
and data requirements for the sector erase command sequence.
The device does not require the system to preprogram prior to erase. The Em-
bedded Erase algorithm automatically programs and verifies the entire memory
for an all zero data pattern prior to electrical erase. The system is not required to
provide any controls or timings during these operations.
After the command sequence is written, a sector erase time-out of 50 µs occurs.
During the time-out period, additional sector addresses and sector erase com-
mands may be written. Loading the sector erase buffer may be done in any
sequence, and the number of sectors may be from one sector to all sectors. The
time between these additional cycles must be less than 50 µs, otherwise erasure
may begin. Any sector erase address and command following the exceeded time-
out may or may not be accepted. It is recommended that processor interrupts be
disabled during this time to ensure all commands are accepted. The interrupts
can be re-enabled after the last Sector Erase command is written. Any com-
mand other than Sector Erase or Erase Suspend during the time-out
period resets that bank to the read mode. The system must rewrite the com-
mand sequence and any additional addresses and commands. Note that SecSi
Sector, autoselect, and CFI functions are unavailable when a [program/erase]
operation is in progress.
The system can monitor DQ3 to determine if the sector erase timer has timed out
(See the section on DQ3: Sector Erase Timer). The time-out begins from the ris-
ing edge of the final WE# pulse in the command sequence.
When the Embedded Erase algorithm is complete, the bank returns to reading
array data and addresses are no longer latched. Note that while the Embedded
Erase operation is in progress, the system can read data from the non-erasing
bank. The system can determine the status of the erase operation by reading
DQ7, DQ6, DQ2, or RY/BY# in the erasing bank. Refer to the Write Operation Sta-
tus section for information on these status bits.
Once the sector erase operation has begun, only the Erase Suspend command is
valid. All other commands are ignored. However, note that a hardware reset im-
mediately terminates the erase operation. If that occurs, the sector erase
command sequence should be reinitiated once that bank has returned to reading
array data, to ensure data integrity.
5 illustrates the algorithm for the erase operation. Refer to the Erase/Program
Operations tables in the AC Characteristics section for parameters, and Figure 16
section for timing diagrams.
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 67
Preliminary
Erase Suspend/Erase Resume Commands
The Erase Suspend command, B0h, allows the system to interrupt a sector erase
operation and then read data from, or program data to, any sector not selected
for erasure. The bank address is required when writing this command. This com-
mand is valid only during the sector erase operation, including the 80 µs time-out
period during the sector erase command sequence. The Erase Suspend command
is ignored if written during the chip erase operation or Embedded Program
algorithm.
When the Erase Suspend command is written during the sector erase operation,
the device requires a maximum of 35 µs to suspend the erase operation. How-
ever, when the Erase Suspend command is written during the sector erase
time-out, the device immediately terminates the time-out period and suspends
the erase operation. Addresses are “don’t-cares” when writing the Erase suspend
command.
After the erase operation has been suspended, the bank enters the erase-sus-
pend-read mode. The system can read data from or program data to any sector
not selected for erasure. (The device “erase suspends” all sectors selected for
erasure.) Reading at any address within erase-suspended sectors produces sta-
tus information on DQ7–DQ0. The system can use DQ7, or DQ6 and DQ2
together, to determine if a sector is actively erasing or is erase-suspended. Refer
to the Write Operation Status section for information on these status bits.
After an erase-suspended program operation is complete, the bank returns to the
erase-suspend-read mode. The system can determine the status of the program
Notes:
1. See Table 17 for erase command sequence.
2. See the section on DQ3 for information on the sector erase timer.
Figure 5. Erase Operation
START
Write Erase
Command Sequence
(Notes 1, 2)
Data Poll to Erasing
Bank from System
Data = FFh?
No
Yes
Erasure Completed
Embedded
Erase
algorithm
in progress
68 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
operation using the DQ7 or DQ6 status bits, just as in the standard Word Program
operation. Refer to the Write Operation Status section for more information.
In the erase-suspend-read mode, the system can also issue the autoselect com-
mand sequence. The device allows reading autoselect codes even at addresses
within erasing sectors, since the codes are not stored in the memory array. When
the device exits the autoselect mode, the device reverts to the Erase Suspend
mode, and is ready for another valid operation. Refer to the SecSiTM Sector Ad-
dresses and the Autoselect Command Sequence sections for details.
To resume the sector erase operation, the system must write the Erase Resume
command (address bits are don’t care). The bank address of the erase-sus-
pended bank is required when writing this command. Further writes of the
Resume command are ignored. Another Erase Suspend command can be written
after the chip has resumed erasing.
Password Program Command
The Password Program Command permits programming the password that is
used as part of the hardware protection scheme. The actual password is 64-bits
long. Four Password Program commands are required to program the password.
The system must enter the unlock cycle, password program command (38h) and
the program address/data for each portion of the password when programming.
There are no provisions for entering the 2-cycle unlock cycle, the password pro-
gram command, and all the password data. There is no special addressing order
required for programming the password. Also, when the password is undergoing
programming, Simultaneous Operation is disabled. Read operations to any mem-
ory location will return the programming status. Once programming is complete,
the user must issue a Read/Reset command to return the device to normal oper-
ation. Once the Password is written and verified, the Password Mode Locking Bit
must be set in order to prevent verification. The Password Program Command is
only capable of programming “0”s. Programming a “1” after a cell is programmed
as a “0” results in a time-out by the Embedded Program Algorithm™ with the cell
remaining as a “0”. The password is all ones when shipped from the factory. All
64-bit password combinations are valid as a password.
Password Verify Command
The Password Verify Command is used to verify the Password. The Password is
verifiable only when the Password Mode Locking Bit is not programmed. If the
Password Mode Locking Bit is programmed and the user attempts to verify the
Password, the device will always drive all F’s onto the DQ data bus.
The Password Verify command is permitted if the SecSi sector is enabled. Also,
the device will not operate in Simultaneous Operation when the Password Verify
command is executed. Only the password is returned regardless of the bank ad-
dress. The lower two address bits (A1-A0) are valid during the Password Verify.
Writing the Read/Reset command returns the device back to normal operation.
Password Protection Mode Locking Bit Program Command
The Password Protection Mode Locking Bit Program Command programs the
Password Protection Mode Locking Bit, which prevents further verifies or updates
to the Password. Once programmed, the Password Protection Mode Locking Bit
cannot be erased! If the Password Protection Mode Locking Bit is verified as pro-
gram without margin, the Password Protection Mode Locking Bit Program
command can be executed to improve the program margin. Once the Password
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 69
Preliminary
Protection Mode Locking Bit is programmed, the Persistent Sector Protection
Locking Bit program circuitry is disabled, thereby forcing the device to remain in
the Password Protection mode. Exiting the Mode Locking Bit Program command
is accomplished by writing the Read/Reset command.
Persistent Sector Protection Mode Locking Bit Program Command
The Persistent Sector Protection Mode Locking Bit Program Command programs
the Persistent Sector Protection Mode Locking Bit, which prevents the Password
Mode Locking Bit from ever being programmed. If the Persistent Sector Protec-
tion Mode Locking Bit is verified as programmed without margin, the Persistent
Sector Protection Mode Locking Bit Program Command should be reissued to im-
prove program margin. By disabling the program circuitry of the Password Mode
Locking Bit, the device is forced to remain in the Persistent Sector Protection
mode of operation, once this bit is set. Exiting the Persistent Protection Mode
Locking Bit Program command is accomplished by writing the Read/Reset
command.
SecSi Sector Protection Bit Program Command
The SecSi Sector Protection Bit Program Command programs the SecSi Sector
Protection Bit, which prevents the SecSi sector memory from being cleared. If the
SecSi Sector Protection Bit is verified as programmed without margin, the SecSi
Sector Protection Bit Program Command should be reissued to improve program
margin. Exiting the VCC-level SecSi Sector Protection Bit Program Command is
accomplished by writing the Read/Reset command.
PPB Lock Bit Set Command
The PPB Lock Bit Set command is used to set the PPB Lock bit if it is cleared either
at reset or if the Password Unlock command was successfully executed. There is
no PPB Lock Bit Clear command. Once the PPB Lock Bit is set, it cannot be cleared
unless the device is taken through a power-on clear or the Password Unlock com-
mand is executed. Upon setting the PPB Lock Bit, the PPBs are latched into the
DYBs. If the Password Mode Locking Bit is set, the PPB Lock Bit status is reflected
as set, even after a power-on reset cycle. Exiting the PPB Lock Bit Set command
is accomplished by writing the Read/Reset command (only in the Persistent Pro-
tection Mode).
DYB Write Command
The DYB Write command is used to set or clear a DYB for a given sector. The high
order address bits (Amax–A12) are issued at the same time as the code 01h or
00h on DQ7-DQ0. All other DQ data bus pins are ignored during the data write
cycle. The DYBs are modifiable at any time, regardless of the state of the PPB or
PPB Lock Bit. The DYBs are cleared at power-up or hardware reset.Exiting the
DYB Write command is accomplished by writing the Read/Reset command.
Password Unlock Command
The Password Unlock command is used to clear the PPB Lock Bit so that the PPBs
can be unlocked for modification, thereby allowing the PPBs to become accessible
for modification. The exact password must be entered in order for the unlocking
function to occur. This command cannot be issued any faster than 2 µs at a time
to prevent a hacker from running through all 64-bit combinations in an attempt
to correctly match a password. If the command is issued before the 2 µs execu-
tion window for each portion of the unlock, the command will be ignored.
70 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
Once the Password Unlock command is entered, the RY/BY# indicates that the
device is busy. Approximately 1 µs is required for each portion of the unlock. Once
the first portion of the password unlock completes (RY/BY# is not low or DQ6
does not toggle when read), the next part of the password is written. The system
must thus monitor RY/BY# or the status bits to confirm when to write the next
portion of the password. Seven cycles are required to successfully clear the PPB
Lock Bit.
PPB Program Command
The PPB Program command is used to program, or set, a given PPB. Each PPB is
individually programmed (but is bulk erased with the other PPBs). The specific
sector address (A22–A12) are written at the same time as the program command
60h with A6 = 0. If the PPB Lock Bit is set and the corresponding PPB is set for
the sector, the PPB Program command will not execute and the command will
time-out without programming the PPB.
After programming a PPB, two additional cycles are needed to determine whether
the PPB has been programmed with margin. If the PPB has been programmed
without margin, the program command should be reissued to improve the pro-
gram margin. Also note that the total number of PPB program/erase cycles is
limited to 100 cycles. Cycling the PPBs beyond 100 cycles is not guaranteed.
The PPB Program command does not follow the Embedded Program algorithm.
All PPB Erase Command
The All PPB Erase command is used to erase all PPBs in bulk. There is no means
for individually erasing a specific PPB. Unlike the PPB program, no specific sector
address is required. However, when the PPB erase command is written all Sector
PPBs are erased in parallel. If the PPB Lock Bit is set the ALL PPB Erase command
will not execute and the command will time-out without erasing the PPBs. After
erasing the PPBs, two additional cycles are needed to determine whether the PPB
has been erased with margin. If the PPBs has been erased without margin, the
erase command should be reissued to improve the program margin.
It is the responsibility of the user to preprogram all PPBs prior to issuing the All
PPB Erase command. If the user attempts to erase a cleared PPB, over-erasure
may occur making it difficult to program the PPB at a later time. Also note that
the total number of PPB program/erase cycles is limited to 100 cycles. Cycling the
PPBs beyond 100 cycles is not guaranteed.
DYB Write Command
The DYB Write command is used for setting the DYB, which is a volatile bit that
is cleared at reset. There is one DYB per sector. If the PPB is set, the sector is
protected regardless of the value of the DYB. If the PPB is cleared, setting the
DYB to a 1 protects the sector from programs or erases. Since this is a volatile
bit, removing power or resetting the device will clear the DYBs. The bank address
is latched when the command is written.
PPB Lock Bit Set Command
The PPB Lock Bit set command is used for setting the DYB, which is a volatile bit
that is cleared at reset. There is one DYB per sector. If the PPB is set, the sector
is protected regardless of the value of the DYB. If the PPB is cleared, setting the
DYB to a 1 protects the sector from programs or erases. Since this is a volatile
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 71
Preliminary
bit, removing power or resetting the device will clear the DYBs. The bank address
is latched when the command is written.
Command
The programming of either the PPB or DYB for a given sector or sector group can
be verified by writing a Sector Protection Status command to the device.
Note that there is no single command to independently verify the programming
of a DYB for a given sector group.
Command Definitions Tables
Ta bl e 1 7 . Memory Array Command Definitions
Command (Notes)
Cycles
Bus Cycles (Notes 14)
Addr Data Addr Data Addr Data Addr Data Addr Data Addr Data
Read (Note 5) 1RA RD
Reset (Note 6) 1XXX F0
Autoselect
(Note 7)
Manufacturer ID 4555 AA 2AA 55 (BA)
555 90 (BA)
X00 01
Device ID (Note 10) 6555 AA 2AA 55 (BA)
555 90 (BA)
X01 227E (BA)
X0E
(Note
10)
(BA)
X0F
(Note
10)
SecSi Sector Factory
Protect (Note 8) 4555 AA 2AA 55 (BA)
555 90 X03 (Note
8)
Sector Group Protect
Verify (Note 9) 4555 AAA 2AA 55 (BA)
555 90 (SA)
X02
XX00/
XX01
Program 4555 AA 2AA 55 555 A0 PA PD
Chip Erase 6555 AA 2AA 55 555 80 555 AA 2AA 55 555 10
Sector Erase 6555 AA 2AA 55 555 80 555 AA 2AA 55 SA 30
Program/Erase Suspend (Note 11) 1BA B0
Program/Erase Resume (Note 12) 1BA 30
CFI Query (Note 13) 155 98
Accelerated Program (Note 15) 2XX A0 PA PD
Unlock Bypass Entry (Note 15) 3555 AA 2AA 55 555 20
Unlock Bypass Program (Note 15) 2XX A0 PA PD
Unlock Bypass Erase (Note 15) 2XX 80 XX 10
Unlock Bypass CFI (Notes 13, 15) 1 XX 98
Unlock Bypass Reset (Note 15) 2XXX 90 XXX 00
72 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
Ta b l e 1 8 . Sector Protection Command Definitions
Command (Notes)
Cycles
Bus Cycles (Notes 1-4)
Addr Data Addr Data Addr Data Addr Data Addr Data Addr Data Addr Data
Reset 1XXX F0
SecSi Sector Entry 3555 AA 2AA 55 555 88
SecSi Sector Exit 4555 AA 2AA 55 555 90 XX 00
SecSi Protection Bit
Program (Notes 5, 6)6555 AA 2AA 55 555 60 OW 68 OW 48 OW RD(0)
SecSi Protection Bit
Status 5555 AA 2AA 55 555 60 OW 48 OW RD(0)
Password Program
(Notes 5, 7, 8)4555 AA 2AA 55 555 38 XX[0-3] PD[0-3]
Password Verify (Notes
6, 8, 9)4555 AA 2AA 55 555 C8 PWA[0-3] PWD[0-3]
Password Unlock (Notes
7, 10, 11)7555 AA 2AA 55 555 28 PWA[0] PWD[0] PWA[1] PWD[1] PWA[2] PWD[2] PWA[3] PWD[3]
PPB Program (Notes 5,
6, 12)6555 AA 2AA 55 555 60 (SA)WP 68 (SA)WP 48 (SA)WP RD(0)
PPB Status 4555 AA 2AA 55 555 90 (SA)WP RD(0)
All PPB Erase (Notes 5,
6, 13, 14)6555 AA 2AA 55 555 60 WP 60 (SA) 40 (SA)WP RD(0)
PPB Lock Bit Set 3555 AA 2AA 55 555 78
PPB Lock Bit Status
(Note 15) 4555 AA 2AA 55 555 58 SA RD(1)
DYB Write (Note 7) 4555 AA 2AA 55 555 48 SA X1
DYB Erase (Note 7) 4555 AA 2AA 55 555 48 SA X0
DYB Status (Note 6) 4555 AA 2AA 55 555 58 SA RD(0)
PPMLB Program (Notes
5, 6, 12)6555 AA 2AA 55 555 60 PL 68 PL 48 PL RD(0)
PPMLB Status (Note 5) 5555 AA 2AA 55 555 60 PL 48 PL RD(0)
SPMLB Program (Notes
5, 6, 12)6555 AA 2AA 55 555 60 SL 68 SL 48 SL RD(0)
SPMLB Status (Note 5) 5555 AA 2AA 55 555 60 SL 48 SL RD(0)
Legend:
BA = Address of bank switching to autoselect mode, bypass
mode, or erase operation. Determined by PL127J: Amax:A20,
PL064J: Amax:A19, PL032J: Amax:A18.
PA = Program Address (Amax:A0). Addresses latch on falling
edge of WE# or CE# pulse, whichever happens later.
PD = Program Data (DQ15:DQ0) written to location PA. Data
latches on rising edge of WE# or CE# pulse, whichever happens
first.
RA = Read Address (Amax:A0).
RD = Read Data (DQ15:DQ0) from location RA.
SA = Sector Address (Amax:A12) for verifying (in autoselect
mode) or erasing.
WD = Write Data. See “Configuration Register” definition for
specific write data. Data latched on rising edge of WE#.
X = Don’t care
Notes:
1. See Table 1 for description of bus operations.
2. All values are in hexadecimal.
3. Shaded cells in table denote read cycles. All other cycles are
write operations.
4. During unlock and command cycles, when lower address bits
are 555 or 2AAh as shown in table, address bits higher than
A11 (except where BA is required) and data bits higher than
DQ7 are don’t cares.
5. No unlock or command cycles required when bank is reading
array data.
6. The Reset command is required to return to reading array
(or to erase-suspend-read mode if previously in Erase
Suspend) when bank is in autoselect mode, or if DQ5 goes
high (while bank is providing status information).
7. Fourth cycle of autoselect command sequence is a read
cycle. System must provide bank address to obtain
manufacturer ID or device ID information. See Autoselect
Command Sequence section for more information.
8. The data is C0h for factory and customer locked and 80h for
factory locked.
9. The data is 00h for an unprotected sector group and 01h fo
r
a protected sector group.
10. Device ID must be read across cycles 4, 5, and 6. PL127J
(X0Eh = 2220h, X0Fh = 2200h),PL064J (X0Eh = 2202h,
X0Fh = 2201h), PL032J (X0Eh = 220Ah, X0Fh = 2201h).
11. System may read and program in non-erasing sectors, or
enter autoselect mode, when in Program/Erase Suspend
mode. Program/Erase Suspend command is valid only
during a sector erase operation, and requires bank address.
12. Program/Erase Resume command is valid only during Erase
Suspend mode, and requires bank address.
13. Command is valid when device is ready to read array data o
r
when device is in autoselect mode.
14. WP#/ACC must be at VID during the entire operation of
command.
15. Unlock Bypass Entry command is required prior to any
Unlock Bypass operation. Unlock Bypass Reset command is
required to return to the reading array.
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 73
Preliminary
Write Operation Status
The device provides several bits to determine the status of a program or erase opera-
tion: DQ2, DQ3, DQ5, DQ6, and DQ7. Table 19 and the following subsections describe
the function of these bits. DQ7 and DQ6 each offer a method for determining whether
a program or erase operation is complete or in progress. The device also provides a
hardware-based output signal, RY/BY#, to determine whether an Embedded Program
or Erase operation is in progress or has been completed.
DQ7: Data# Polling
The Data# Polling bit, DQ7, indicates to the host system whether an Embedded Pro-
gram or Erase algorithm is in progress or completed, or whether a bank is in Erase
Suspend. Data# Polling is valid after the rising edge of the final WE# pulse in the com-
mand sequence.
During the Embedded Program algorithm, the device outputs on DQ7 the complement
of the datum programmed to DQ7. This DQ7 status also applies to programming during
Erase Suspend. When the Embedded Program algorithm is complete, the device out-
puts the datum programmed to DQ7. The system must provide the program address
to read valid status information on DQ7. If a program address falls within a protected
sector, Data# Polling on DQ7 is active for approximately 1 µs, then that bank returns
to the read mode.
During the Embedded Erase algorithm, Data# Polling produces a “0” on DQ7.
When the Embedded Erase algorithm is complete, or if the bank enters the Erase
Suspend mode, Data# Polling produces a “1” on DQ7. The system must provide
an address within any of the sectors selected for erasure to read valid status in-
formation on DQ7.
After an erase command sequence is written, if all sectors selected for erasing
are protected, Data# Polling on DQ7 is active for approximately 400 µs, then the
L
egend:
D
YB = Dynamic Protection Bit
O
W = Address (A7:A0) is (00011010)
P
D[3:0] = Password Data (1 of 4 portions)
P
PB = Persistent Protection Bit
P
WA = Password Address. A1:A0 selects portion of password.
P
WD = Password Data being verified.
P
L = Password Protection Mode Lock Address (A7:A0) is
(00001010)
RD(0) = Read Data DQ0 for protection indicator bit.
RD(1) = Read Data DQ1 for PPB Lock status.
SA = Sector Address where security command applies. Address
bits Amax:A12 uniquely select any sector.
SL = Persistent Protection Mode Lock Address (A7:A0) is
(00010010)
WP = PPB Address (A7:A0) is (00000010)
X = Don’t care
PPMLB = Password Protection Mode Locking Bit
SPMLB = Persistent Protection Mode Locking Bit
N
otes:
1. See Table 1 for description of bus operations.
2
. All values are in hexadecimal.
3
. Shaded cells in table denote read cycles. All other cycles are
write operations.
4
. During unlock and command cycles, when lower address bits
are 555 or 2AAh as shown in table, address bits higher than
A11 (except where BA is required) and data bits higher than
DQ7 are don’t cares.
5
. The reset command returns device to reading array.
6
. Cycle 4 programs the addressed locking bit. Cycles 5 and 6
validate bit has been fully programmed when DQ0 = 1. If
DQ0 = 0 in cycle 6, program command must be issued and
verified again.
7. Data is latched on the rising edge of WE#.
8
. Entire command sequence must be entered for each portion
of password.
9. Command sequence returns FFh if PPMLB is set.
10. The password is written over four consecutive cycles, at
addresses 0-3.
11. A 2 µs timeout is required between any two portions of
password.
12. A 100 µs timeout is required between cycles 4 and 5.
13. A 1.2 ms timeout is required between cycles 4 and 5.
14. Cycle 4 erases all PPBs. Cycles 5 and 6 validate bits have
been fully erased when DQ0 = 0. If DQ0 = 1 in cycle 6,
erase command must be issued and verified again. Before
issuing erase command, all PPBs should be programmed to
prevent PPB overerasure.
15. DQ1 = 1 if PPB locked, 0 if unlocked.
74 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
bank returns to the read mode. If not all selected sectors are protected, the Em-
bedded Erase algorithm erases the unprotected sectors, and ignores the selected
sectors that are protected. However, if the system reads DQ7 at an address within
a protected sector, the status may not be valid.
When the system detects DQ7 has changed from the complement to true data,
it can read valid data at DQ15–DQ0 on the following read cycles. Just prior to the
completion of an Embedded Program or Erase operation, DQ7 may change asyn-
chronously with DQ15–DQ0 while Output Enable (OE#) is asserted low. That is,
the device may change from providing status information to valid data on DQ7.
Depending on when the system samples the DQ7 output, it may read the status
or valid data. Even if the device has completed the program or erase operation
and DQ7 has valid data, the data outputs on DQ15–DQ0 may be still invalid. Valid
data on DQ15–DQ0 will appear on successive read cycles.
Ta ble 19 shows the outputs for Data# Polling on DQ7. 6 shows the Data# Polling
algorithm. 18 in the AC Characteristic section shows the Data# Polling timing
diagram.
Notes:
1. VA = Valid address for programming. During a sector erase operation, a valid address is
any sector address within the sector being erased. During chip erase, a valid address is
any non-protected sector address.
2. DQ7 should be rechecked even if DQ5 = “1” because DQ7 may change simultaneously
with DQ5.
Figure 6. Data# Polling Algorithm
DQ7 = Data? Yes
No
No
DQ5 = 1?
No
Yes
Yes
FAIL PASS
Read DQ7–DQ0
Addr = VA
Read DQ7–DQ0
Addr = VA
DQ7 = Data?
START
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 75
Preliminary
RY/BY#: Ready/Busy#
The RY/BY# is a dedicated, open-drain output pin which indicates whether an
Embedded Algorithm is in progress or complete. The RY/BY# status is valid after
the rising edge of the final WE# pulse in the command sequence. Since RY/BY#
is an open-drain output, several RY/BY# pins can be tied together in parallel with
a pull-up resistor to VCC.
If the output is low (Busy), the device is actively erasing or programming. (This
includes programming in the Erase Suspend mode.) If the output is high (Ready),
the device is in the read mode, the standby mode, or one of the banks is in the
erase-suspend-read mode.
Ta ble 19 shows the outputs for RY/BY#.
DQ6: Toggle Bit I
Toggle Bit I on DQ6 indicates whether an Embedded Program or Erase algorithm
is in progress or complete, or whether the device has entered the Erase Suspend
mode. Toggle Bit I may be read at any address, and is valid after the rising edge
of the final WE# pulse in the command sequence (prior to the program or erase
operation), and during the sector erase time-out.
During an Embedded Program or Erase algorithm operation, successive read cy-
cles to any address cause DQ6 to toggle. The system may use either OE# or CE#
to control the read cycles. When the operation is complete, DQ6 stops toggling.
After an erase command sequence is written, if all sectors selected for erasing
are protected, DQ6 toggles for approximately 400 µs, then returns to reading
array data. If not all selected sectors are protected, the Embedded Erase algo-
rithm erases the unprotected sectors, and ignores the selected sectors that are
protected.
The system can use DQ6 and DQ2 together to determine whether a sector is ac-
tively erasing or is erase-suspended. When the device is actively erasing (that is,
the Embedded Erase algorithm is in progress), DQ6 toggles. When the device en-
ters the Erase Suspend mode, DQ6 stops toggling. However, the system must
also use DQ2 to determine which sectors are erasing or erase-suspended. Alter-
natively, the system can use DQ7 (see the DQ7: Data# Polling).
If a program address falls within a protected sector, DQ6 toggles for approxi-
mately 1 µs after the program command sequence is written, then returns to
reading array data.
DQ6 also toggles during the erase-suspend-program mode, and stops toggling
once the Embedded Program algorithm is complete.
Ta ble 19 shows the outputs for Toggle Bit I on DQ6. Figure 7 shows the toggle bit
algorithm. Figure 19 in “Read Operation Timings” shows the toggle bit timing di-
agrams. Figure 20 shows the differences between DQ2 and DQ6 in graphical
form. See also the DQ2: Toggle Bit II.
76 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
DQ2: Toggle Bit II
The “Toggle Bit II” on DQ2, when used with DQ6, indicates whether a particular
sector is actively erasing (that is, the Embedded Erase algorithm is in progress),
or whether that sector is erase-suspended. Toggle Bit II is valid after the rising
edge of the final WE# pulse in the command sequence.
DQ2 toggles when the system reads at addresses within those sectors that have
been selected for erasure. (The system may use either OE# or CE# to control the
read cycles.) But DQ2 cannot distinguish whether the sector is actively erasing or
is erase-suspended. DQ6, by comparison, indicates whether the device is actively
erasing, or is in Erase Suspend, but cannot distinguish which sectors are selected
for erasure. Thus, both status bits are required for sector and mode information.
Refer to Ta b l e 19 to compare outputs for DQ2 and DQ6.
Figure 7 shows the toggle bit algorithm in flowchart form, and the DQ2: Toggle
Bit II explains the algorithm. See also the DQ6: Toggle Bit I. Figure 19 shows the
toggle bit timing diagram. Figure 20 shows the differences between DQ2 and DQ6
in graphical form.
Reading Toggle Bits DQ6/DQ2
Refer to Figure 7 for the following discussion. Whenever the system initially be-
gins reading toggle bit status, it must read DQ7–DQ0 at least twice in a row to
determine whether a toggle bit is toggling. Typically, the system would note and
Note: The system should recheck the toggle bit even if DQ5 = “1” because the toggle
bit may stop toggling as DQ5 changes to “1.” See the DQ6: Toggle Bit I and DQ2:
Toggle Bit II for more information.
Figure 7. Toggle Bit Algorithm
START
No
Yes
Yes
DQ5 = 1?
No
Yes
Toggle Bit
= Toggle? No
Program/Erase
Operation Not
Complete, Write
Reset Command
Program/Erase
Operation Complet
e
Toggle Bit
= Toggle?
Read Byte Twice
(DQ7–DQ0)
Address = VA
Read Byte
(DQ7–DQ0)
Address =VA
Read Byte
(DQ7–DQ0)
Address =VA
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 77
Preliminary
store the value of the toggle bit after the first read. After the second read, the
system would compare the new value of the toggle bit with the first. If the toggle
bit is not toggling, the device has completed the program or erase operation. The
system can read array data on DQ7–DQ0 on the following read cycle.
However, if after the initial two read cycles, the system determines that the toggle
bit is still toggling, the system also should note whether the value of DQ5 is high
(see the section on DQ5). If it is, the system should then determine again
whether the toggle bit is toggling, since the toggle bit may have stopped toggling
just as DQ5 went high. If the toggle bit is no longer toggling, the device has suc-
cessfully completed the program or erase operation. If it is still toggling, the
device did not completed the operation successfully, and the system must write
the reset command to return to reading array data.
The remaining scenario is that the system initially determines that the toggle bit
is toggling and DQ5 has not gone high. The system may continue to monitor the
toggle bit and DQ5 through successive read cycles, determining the status as de-
scribed in the previous paragraph. Alternatively, it may choose to perform other
system tasks. In this case, the system must start at the beginning of the algo-
rithm when it returns to determine the status of the operation (top of Figure 7).
DQ5: Exceeded Timing Limits
DQ5 indicates whether the program or erase time has exceeded a specified inter-
nal pulse count limit. Under these conditions DQ5 produces a “1,” indicating that the
program or erase cycle was not successfully completed.
The device may output a “1” on DQ5 if the system tries to program a “1” to a
location that was previously programmed to “0.Only an erase operation can
change a “0” back to a “1.” Under this condition, the device halts the opera-
tion, and when the timing limit has been exceeded, DQ5 produces a “1.
Under both these conditions, the system must write the reset command to return
to the read mode (or to the erase-suspend-read mode if a bank was previously
in the erase-suspend-program mode).
DQ3: Sector Erase Timer
After writing a sector erase command sequence, the system may read DQ3 to de-
termine whether or not erasure has begun. (The sector erase timer does not
apply to the chip erase command.) If additional sectors are selected for erasure,
the entire time-out also applies after each additional sector erase command.
When the time-out period is complete, DQ3 switches from a “0” to a “1.” See also
the Sector Erase Command Sequence.
After the sector erase command is written, the system should read the status of
DQ7 (Data# Polling) or DQ6 (Toggle Bit I) to ensure that the device has accepted
the command sequence, and then read DQ3. If DQ3 is “1,” the Embedded Erase
algorithm has begun; all further commands (except Erase Suspend) are ignored
until the erase operation is complete. If DQ3 is “0,” the device will accept addi-
tional sector erase commands. To ensure the command has been accepted, the
system software should check the status of DQ3 prior to and following each sub-
sequent sector erase command. If DQ3 is high on the second status check, the
last command might not have been accepted.
Ta ble 19 shows the status of DQ3 relative to the other status bits.
78 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
Notes:
1. DQ5 switches to ‘1’ when an Embedded Program or Embedded Erase operation has exceeded the maximum timing
limits. Refer to the section on DQ5 for more information.
2. DQ7 and DQ2 require a valid address when reading status information. Refer to the appropriate subsection for
further details.
3. When reading write operation status bits, the system must always provide the bank address where the Embedded
Algorithm is in progress. The device outputs array data if the system addresses a non-busy bank.
Ta b l e 1 9 . Write Operation Status
Status
DQ7
(Note 2) DQ6
DQ5
(Note 1) DQ3
DQ2
(Note 2) RY/BY#
Standard
Mode
Embedded Program Algorithm DQ7# To g g l e 0N/A No toggle 0
Embedded Erase Algorithm 0To gg l e 0 1 Toggle 0
Erase
Suspend
Mode
Erase-Suspend-
Read
Erase
Suspended Sector 1No toggle 0N/A Toggle 1
Non-Erase
Suspended Sector Data Data Data Data Data 1
Erase-Suspend-Program DQ7# To g g le 0N/A N/A 0
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 79
Preliminary
Absolute Maximum Ratings
Storage Temperature Plastic Packages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . –65°C to +150°C
Ambient Temperature with Power Applied . . . . . . . . . . . . . . –65°C to +125°C
Voltage with Respect to Ground
VCC (Note 1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .–0.5 V to +4.0 V
A9, OE#, and RESET# (Note 2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . –0.5 V to +13.0 V
WP#/ACC (Note 2). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . –0.5 V to +10.5 V
All other pins (Note 1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .–0.5 V to VCC +0.5 V
Output Short Circuit Current (Note 3). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200 mA
Notes:
1. Minimum DC voltage on input or I/O pins is –0.5 V. During voltage transitions,
input or I/O pins may overshoot VSS to –2.0 V for periods of up to 20 ns. Maximum
DC voltage on input or I/O pins is VCC +0.5 V. During voltage transitions, input or
I/O pins may overshoot to VCC +2.0 V for periods up to 20 ns. See Figure 8.
2. Minimum DC input voltage on pins A9, OE#, RESET#, and WP#/ACC is –0.5 V.
During voltage transitions, A9, OE#, WP#/ACC, and RESET# may overshoot VSS
to2.0 V for periods of up to 20 ns. See Figure 8. Maximum DC input voltage on
pin A9, OE#, and RESET# is +12.5 V which may overshoot to +14.0 V for periods
up to 20 ns. Maximum DC input voltage on WP#/ACC is +9.5 V which may
overshoot to +12.0 V for periods up to 20 ns.
3. No more than one output may be shorted to ground at a time. Duration of the
short circuit should not be greater than one second.
4. Stresses above those listed under “Absolute Maximum Ratings” may cause perma-
nent damage to the device. This is a stress rating only; functional operation of the
device at these or any other conditions above those indicated in the operational
sections of this data sheet is not implied. Exposure of the device to absolute max-
imum rating conditions for extended periods may affect device reliability.
Figure 8. Maximum Overshoot Waveforms
20
ns
20 ns
+0.8 V
–0.5 V
20
ns
–2.0 V
20 ns
20
ns
V
CC
+2.0 V
V
CC
+0.5 V
20 ns
2.0 V
Maximum Negative Overshoot Waveform Maximum Positive Overshoot Waveform
80 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
Operating Ranges
Operating ranges define those limits between which the functionality of the de-
vice is guaranteed.
Industrial (I) Devices
Ambient Temperature (TA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . –40°C to +85°C
Extended (E) Devices
Ambient Temperature (TA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . –55°C to +125°C
Supply Voltages
VCC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2.7–3.6 V
VIO (see Note) . . 1.65–1.95 V (for PL127J) or 2.7–3.6 V (for all PLxxxJ devices)
Notes:
For all AC and DC specifications, VIO = VCC; contact your local sales office for other
VIO options.
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 81
Preliminary
DC Characteristics
Notes:
1. The ICC current listed is typically less than 5 mA/MHz, with OE# at VIH.
2. Maximum ICC specifications are tested with VCC = VCCmax.
3. ICC active while Embedded Erase or Embedded Program is in progress.
4. Automatic sleep mode enables the low power mode when addresses remain stable for tACC + 30 ns. Typical sleep
mode current is 1 mA.
5. Not 100% tested.
6. Valid CE1#/CE2# conditions: (CE1# = VIL, CE2# = VIH,) or (CE1# = VIH, CE2# = VIL) or (CE1# = VIH, CE2# = VIH)
Ta b l e 2 0 . CMOS Compatible
Parameter
Symbol Parameter Description Test Conditions Min Typ Max Unit
ILI Input Load Current VIN = VSS to VCC,
VCC = VCC max ±1.0 µA
ILIT A9, OE#, RESET# Input Load Current VCC = VCC max; VID= 12.5 V 35 µA
ILR Reset Leakage Current VCC = VCC max; VID= 12.5 V 35 µA
ILO Output Leakage Current VOUT = VSS to VCC, OE# = VIH
VCC = VCC max ±1.0 µA
ICC1 VCC Active Read Current (Notes 1, 2) OE# = VIH, VCC = VCC max
(Note 1)
5 MHz 20 30 mA
10 MHz 45 55
ICC2 VCC Active Write Current (Notes 2, 3) OE# = VIH, WE# = VIL 15 25 mA
ICC3 VCC Standby Current (Note 2) CE#, RESET#, WP#/ACC
= VIO ± 0.3 V 0.2 5µA
ICC4 VCC Reset Current (Note 2) RESET# = VSS ± 0.3 V 0.2 5µA
ICC5 Automatic Sleep Mode (Notes 2, 4) VIH = VIO ± 0.3 V;
VIL = VSS ± 0.3 V 0.2 5µA
ICC6
VCC Active Read-While-Program Current
(Notes 1, 2) OE# = VIH,5 MHz 21 45 mA
10 MHz 46 70
ICC7
VCC Active Read-While-Erase Current
(Notes 1, 2) OE# = VIH,5 MHz 21 45 mA
10 MHz 46 70
ICC8
VCC Active Program-While-Erase-
Suspended Current (Notes 2, 5) OE# = VIH 17 25 mA
ICC9 VCC Active Page Read Current (Note 2) OE# = VIH, 8 word Page Read 10 15 mA
VIL Input Low Voltage VIO = 1.65–1.95 V (PL127J) –0.4 0.4 V
VIO = 2.7–3.6 V –0.5 0.8 V
VIH Input High Voltage VIO = 1.65–1.95 V (PL127J) VIO–0.4 VIO+0.4 V
VIO = 2.7–3.6 V 2.0 VCC+0.3 V
VHH Voltage for ACC Program Acceleration VCC = 3.0 V ± 10% 8.5 9.5 V
VID
Voltage for Autoselect and Temporary
Sector Unprotect VCC = 3.0 V ± 10% 11.5 12.5 V
VOL Output Low Voltage
IOL = 100 µA, VCC = VCC min, VIO = 1.65
1.95 V (PL127J) 0.1 V
IOL = 2.0 mA, VCC = VCC min, VIO = 2.7–3.6
V0.4 V
VOH Output High Voltage
IOH = –100 µA, VCC = VCC min, VIO = 1.65–
1.95 V (PL127J) VIO–0.1 V
IOH = –2.0 mA, VCC = VCC min, VIO = 2.7–3.6
V2.4 V
VLKO Low VCC Lock-Out Voltage (Note 5) 2.3 2.5 V
82 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
AC Characteristic
Test Conditions
Note: Diodes are IN3064 or equivalent
Figure 9. Te s t S e t u p s
Ta b l e 2 1 . Test Specifications
Test Condition All Speeds Unit
Output Load 1 TTL gate
Output Load Capacitance, C
L
(including jig capacitance) 30 pF
Input Rise and Fall Times
V
IO
= 1.8 V
(PL127J) 5ns
V
IO
= 3.0 V
Input Pulse Levels
V
IO
= 1.8 V
(PL127J) 0.0 - 1.8
V
V
IO
= 3.0 V 0.0–3.0
Input timing measurement reference levels V
IO
/2 V
Output timing measurement reference levels V
IO
/2 V
2.7 k
CL6.2 k
3
.
6
V
Device
Under
Test
CL
Device
Under
Tes t
VIO = 3.0 V VIO = 1.8 V (PL127J)
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 83
Preliminary
SWITCHING WAVEFORMS
VCC RampRate
All DC characteristics are specified for a VCC ramp rate > 1V/100 µs and VCC
>=VCCQ - 100 mV. If the VCC ramp rate is < 1V/100 µs, a hardware reset
required.+
Ta b l e 2 2 . KEY TO SWITCHING WAVEFORMS
WAVEFORM INPUTS OUTPUTS
Steady
Changing from H to L
Changing from L to H
Don’t Care, Any Change Permitted Changing, State Unknown
Does Not Apply Center Line is High Impedance State (High Z)
Figure 10. Input Waveforms and Measurement Levels
VIO
0.0 V VIO/2 VIO/2 OutputMeasurement LevelIn
84 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
Read Operations
Notes:
1. Not 100% tested.
2. See Figure 9 and Table 21 for test specifications
3. Measurements performed by placing a 50 ohm termination on the data pin with a bias of VCC /2. The time from OE#
high to the data bus driven to VCC /2 is taken as tDF.
4. For 70pF Output Load Capacitance, 2 ns will be added to the above tACC,tCE,tPACC,tOE values for all speed grades
Ta b l e 2 3 . Read-Only Operations
Parameter
Description
Te s t S e t u p
Speed Options
JEDEC Std. 55 60 65 70 Unit
t
AVAV
t
RC
Read Cycle Time (Note 1) Min 55 60 65 70 ns
t
AVQV
t
ACC
Address to Output Delay CE#, OE# = V
IL
Max 55 60 65 70 ns
t
ELQV
t
CE
Chip Enable to Output Delay OE# = V
IL
Max 55 60 65 70 ns
t
PACC
Page Access Time Max 20 25 30 ns
t
GLQV
t
OE
Output Enable to Output Delay Max 20 25 30 ns
t
EHQZ
t
DF
Chip Enable to Output High Z (Note 3) Max 16 ns
t
GHQZ
t
DF
Output Enable to Output High Z (Notes 1,
3) Max 16 ns
t
AXQX
t
OH
Output Hold Time From Addresses, CE# or
OE#, Whichever Occurs First (Note 3) Min 5ns
t
OEH
Output Enable Hold
Time (Note 1)
Read Min 0ns
Toggle and
Data# Polling Min 10 ns
Figure 11. Read Operation Timings
t
OH
t
CE
Data
WE#
Addresses
CE#
OE#
HIGH Z
Valid Data
HIGH Z
Addresses Stable
t
RC
t
ACC
t
OEH
t
RH
t
OE
t
RH
0 V
RY/BY#
RESET#
t
DF
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 85
Preliminary
Reset
Note: Not 100% tested.
Figure 12. Page Read Operation Timings
Ta b l e 2 4 . Hardware Reset (RESET#)
Parameter
Description All Speed Options UnitJEDEC Std
t
Ready
RESET# Pin Low (During Embedded Algorithms)
to Read Mode (See Note) Max 35 µs
t
Ready
RESET# Pin Low (NOT During Embedded
Algorithms) to Read Mode (See Note) Max 500 ns
t
RP
RESET# Pulse Width Min 500 ns
t
RH
Reset High Time Before Read (See Note) Min 50 ns
t
RPD
RESET# Low to Standby Mode Min 20 µs
t
RB
RY/BY# Recovery Time Min 0ns
A
max
-
A3
CE#
OE#
A2
-
A0
Data
Same Page
Aa Ab Ac Ad
Qa Qb Qc Qd
t
ACC
t
PACC
t
PACC
t
PACC
86 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
Figure 13. Reset Timings
RESET#
RY/BY#
RY/BY#
tRP
tReady
Reset Timings NOT during Embedded Algorithms
tReady
CE#, OE#
tRH
CE#, OE#
Reset Timings during Embedded Algorithms
RESET#
tRP
tRB
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 87
Preliminary
Erase/Program Operations
Notes:
1. Not 100% tested.
2. See the “Erase And Programming Performance” section for more information.
Ta b l e 2 5 . Erase and Program Operations
Parameter Speed Options
JEDEC Std
Description
55 60 65 70 Unit
t
AVAV
t
WC
Write Cycle Time (Note 1) Min 55 60 65 70 ns
t
AVWL
t
AS
Address Setup Time Min 0ns
t
ASO
Address Setup Time to OE# low during toggle bit
polling Min 15 ns
t
WLAX
t
AH
Address Hold Time Min 30 35 ns
t
AHT
Address Hold Time From CE# or OE# high during
toggle bit polling Min 0ns
t
DVWH
t
DS
Data Setup Time Min 25 30 ns
t
WHDX
t
DH
Data Hold Time Min 0ns
t
OEPH
Output Enable High during toggle bit polling Min 10 ns
t
GHWL
t
GHWL
Read Recovery Time Before Write
(OE# High to WE# Low) Min 0ns
t
ELWL
t
CS
CE# Setup Time Min 0ns
t
WHEH
t
CH
CE# Hold Time Min 0ns
t
WLWH
t
WP
Write Pulse Width Min 35 40 ns
t
WHDL
t
WPH
Write Pulse Width High Min 20 25 ns
t
SR/W
Latency Between Read and Write Operations Min 0ns
t
WHWH1
t
WHWH1
Programming Operation (Note 2) Typ 6µs
t
WHWH1
t
WHWH1
Accelerated Programming Operation (Note 2) Typ 4µs
t
WHWH2
t
WHWH2
Sector Erase Operation (Note 2) Typ 0.5 sec
t
VCS
V
CC
Setup Time (Note 1) Min 50 µs
t
RB
Write Recovery Time from RY/BY# Min 0ns
t
BUSY
Program/Erase Valid to RY/BY# Delay Max 90 ns
88 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
Timing Diagrams
Notes:
1. PA = program address, PD = program data, DOUT is the true data at the program address
Figure 14. Program Operation Timings
Figure 15. Accelerated Program Timing Diagram
OE#
WE#
CE#
VCC
Data
Addresses
tDS
t
AH
t
DH
t
WP
PD
t
WHWH1
t
WC
t
AS
t
WPH
t
VCS
555h PA PA
Read Status Data (last two cycles)
A0h
t
CS
Status D
OUT
Program Command Sequence (last two cycles)
RY/BY#
t
RB
tBUSY
t
CH
PA
W
P#/ACC t
VHH
VHH
VIL or VIH VIL or VIH
tVHH
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 89
Preliminary
Notes:
1. SA = sector address (for Sector Erase), VA = Valid Address for reading status data (see “Write Operation Status”
Figure 16. Chip/Sector Erase Operation Timings
Figure 17. Back-to-back Read/Write Cycle Timings
OE#
CE#
Addresses
V
CC
WE#
Data
2AAh SA
t
AH
t
WP
t
WC
t
AS
t
WPH
555h for chip erase
10 for Chip Erase
30h
t
DS
t
VCS
t
CS
t
DH
55h
t
CH
Status D
OUT
t
WHWH2
VA
VA
Erase Command Sequence (last two cycles) Read Status Data
RY/BY#
t
RB
t
BUSY
OE#
CE#
WE#
Addresses
t
OH
Data
Valid
In Valid
In
Valid PA Valid RA
t
WC
t
WPH
t
AH
t
WP
t
DS
t
DH
t
AS
t
RC
t
CE
t
AH
Valid
Out
t
OE
t
ACC
t
OEH
t
GHWL
t
DF
Valid
In
CE# Controlled Write CyclesWE# Controlled Write Cycle
Valid PA Valid PA
t
CP
t
CPH
t
WC
t
WC
Read Cycle
t
SR/W
t
AS
90 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
Note: VA = Valid address. Illustration shows first status cycle after command sequence, last status read cycle, and
array data read cycle
Figure 18. Data# Polling Timings (During Embedded Algorithms)
Notes:
1. VA = Valid address; not required for DQ6. Illustration shows first two status cycle after command sequence, last
status read cycle, and array data read cycle
Figure 19. Toggle Bit Timings (During Embedded Algorithms)
WE#
CE#
OE#
High Z
t
OE
High Z
DQ7
DQ6–DQ0
RY/BY#
t
BUSY
Complement True
Addresses VA
t
OEH
t
CE
t
CH
t
OH
t
DF
VA VA
Status Data
Complement
Status Data True
Valid Data
Valid Data
t
ACC
t
RC
OE#
CE#
WE#
Addresses
t
OEH
t
DH
t
AHT
t
ASO
t
OEPH
t
OE
Valid Data
(first read) (second read) (stops toggling)
t
CEPH
t
AHT
t
AS
DQ6/DQ2 Valid Dat
a
Valid
Status Valid
Status Valid
Status
RY/BY#
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 91
Preliminary
Protect/Unprotect
Note: Not 100% tested.
Note:Note: DQ2 toggles only when read at an address within an erase-suspended sector. The system may use OE#
or CE# to toggle DQ2 and DQ6.
Figure 20. DQ2 vs. DQ6
Ta b l e 2 6 . Temporary Sector Unprotect
Parameter
All Speed OptionsJEDEC Std
Description
Unit
t
VIDR
V
ID
Rise and Fall Time (See Note) Min 500 ns
t
VHH
V
HH
Rise and Fall Time (See Note) Min 250 ns
t
RSP
RESET# Setup Time for Temporary Sector
Unprotect Min 4µs
t
RRB
RESET# Hold Time from RY/BY# High for
Temporary Sector Unprotect Min 4µs
Figure 21. Temporary Sector Unprotect Timing Diagram
Enter
Erase
Erase
Erase
Enter Erase
Suspend Program
Erase Suspend
Read Erase Suspend
Read
Erase
WE#
DQ6
DQ2
Erase
Complete
Erase
Suspend
Suspend
Program
Resume
Embedded
Erasing
R
ESET#
t
VIDR
V
ID
V
IL
or V
IH
V
ID
V
IL
or V
IH
CE#
WE#
RY/BY#
t
VIDR
t
RSP
Program or Erase Command Sequence
t
RRB
92 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
Notes:
1. For sector protect, A6 = 0, A1 = 1, A0 = 0. For sector unprotect, A6 = 1, A1 = 1, A0 = 0.
Figure 22. Sector/Sector Block Protect and Unprotect Timing Diagram
Sector Group Protect: 150 µs
Sector Group Unprotect: 15 ms
1 µs
R
ESET#
SA, A6,
A1, A0
Data
CE#
WE#
OE#
60h 60h 40h
Valid* Valid* Valid*
Status
Sector Group Protect/Unprotect Verify
VID
VIH
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 93
Preliminary
Controlled Erase Operations
Notes:
1. Not 100% tested.
2. See the “Erase And Programming Performance” section for more information.
Ta bl e 2 7 . Alternate CE# Controlled Erase and Program Operations
Parameter Speed Options
JEDEC Std
Description
55 60 65 70 Unit
t
AVAV
t
WC
Write Cycle Time (Note 1) Min 55 60 65 70 ns
t
AVWL
t
AS
Address Setup Time Min 0ns
t
ELAX
t
AH
Address Hold Time Min 30 35 ns
t
DVEH
t
DS
Data Setup Time Min 25 30 ns
t
EHDX
t
DH
Data Hold Time Min 0ns
t
GHEL
t
GHEL
Read Recovery Time Before Write
(OE# High to WE# Low) Min 0ns
t
WLEL
t
WS
WE# Setup Time Min 0ns
t
EHWH
t
WH
WE# Hold Time Min 0ns
t
ELEH
t
CP
CE# Pulse Width Min 35 40 ns
t
EHEL
t
CPH
CE# Pulse Width High Min 20 25 ns
t
WHWH1
t
WHWH1
Programming Operation (Note 2) Typ 6µs
t
WHWH1
t
WHWH1
Accelerated Programming Operation (Note 2) Typ 4µs
t
WHWH2
t
WHWH2
Sector Erase Operation (Note 2) Typ 0.5 sec
94 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 May 21, 2004
Preliminary
Notes:
1. Figure indicates last two bus cycles of a program or erase operation.
2. PA = program address, SA = sector address, PD = program data.
3. DQ7# is the complement of the data written to the device. DOUT is the data written to the device
Ta b l e 2 8 . Alternate CE# Controlled Write (Erase/Program) Operation Timings
t
GHEL
t
WS
OE#
CE#
WE#
RESET#
t
DS
Data
t
AH
Addresses
t
DH
t
CP
DQ7# D
OUT
t
WC
t
AS
t
CPH
PA
Data# Polling
A0 for program
55 for erase
t
RH
t
WHWH1 or 2
RY/BY#
t
WH
PD for program
30 for sector erase
10 for chip erase
555 for program
2AA for erase PA for program
SA for sector erase
555 for chip erase
t
BUSY
May 21, 2004 S29PL127_064_032J_00_A1 S29PL127J/S29PL064J/S29PL032J for MCP 95
Preliminary
Notes:
1. Typical program and erase times assume the following conditions: 25×C, 3.0 V VCC, 100,000 cycles. Additionally,
programming typicals assume checkerboard pattern. All values are subject to change.
2. Under worst case conditions of 90×C, VCC = 2.7 V, 100,000 cycles. All values are subject to change.
3. The typical chip programming time is considerably less than the maximum chip programming time listed, since most
bytes program faster than the maximum program times listed.
4. In the pre-programming step of the Embedded Erase algorithm, all bytes are programmed to 00h before erasure.
5. System-level overhead is the time required to execute the two- or four-bus-cycle sequence for the program
command. See Table 17 for further information on command definitions.
6. The device has a minimum erase and program cycle endurance of 100,000 cycles.
BGA Pin Capacitance
Notes:
1. Sampled, not 100% tested.
2. Test conditions TA = 25°C, f = 1.0 MHz.
Ta b l e 2 9 . Erase And Programming Performance
Parameter
Ty p (Note 1) Max (Note 2) Unit Comments
Sector Erase Time
0.5 2sec
Excludes 00h programming
prior to erasure (Note 4)
Chip Erase Time
PL127J 135 216 sec
PL064J 71 113.6 sec
PL032J 39 62.4 sec
Word Program Time
6100 µs
Excludes system level
overhead (Note 5)
Accelerated Word Program Time
460 µs
Chip Program Time
(Note 3)
PL127J 50.4 200 sec
PL064J 25.2 50.4 sec
PL032J 12.6 25.2 sec
Parameter Symbol Parameter Description Te s t S e t u p Ty p Max Unit
C
IN
Input Capacitance V
IN
= 0 6.3 7pF
C
OUT
Output Capacitance V
OUT
= 0 7.0 8pF
C
IN2
Control Pin Capacitance V
IN
= 0 5.5 8pF
C
IN3
WP#/ACC Pin Capacitance V
IN
= 0 11 12 pF
May 3, 2004 pSRAM_Type02_15A0 Type 2 pSRAM 97
Preliminary
Type 2 pSRAM
16Mb (1Mb Word x 16-bit)
32Mb (2Mb Word x 16-bit)
64Mb (4Mb Word x 16-bit)
Features
Process Technology: CMOS
Organization: x16 bit
Power Supply Voltage: 2.7~3.1V
Three State Outputs
Compatible with Low Power SRAM
Product Information
Pin Description
Density V
CC
Range
Standby
(ISB1, Max.)
Operating
(ICC2, Max.) Mode
16Mb 2.7-3.1V 80 µA 30 mA Dual CS
16Mb 2.7-3.1V 80 µA 35 mA Dual CS and Page Mode
32Mb 2.7-3.1V 100 µA 35 mA Dual CS
32Mb 2.7-3.1V 100 µA 40 mA Dual CS and Page Mode
64Mb 2.7-3.1V TBD TBD Dual CS
64Mb 2.7-3.1V TBD TBD Dual CS and Page Mode
Pin Name Description I/O
CS1#, CS2 Chip Select I
OE# Output Enable I
WE# Write Enable I
LB#, UB# Lower/Upper Byte Enable I
A0-A19 (16M)
A0-A20 (32M)
A0-A21 (64M)
Address Inputs I
I/O0-I/O15 Data Inputs/Outputs I/O
V
CC
/V
CCQ
Power Supply
V
SS
/V
SSQ
Ground
NC Not Connection
DNU Do Not Use
98 Type 2 pSRAM pSRAM_Type02_15A0 May 3, 2004
Preliminary
Power Up Sequence
1. Apply power.
2. Maintain stable power (VCC min.=2.7V) for a minimum 200 µs with
CS1#=high or CS2=low.
May 3, 2004 pSRAM_Type02_15A0 Type 2 pSRAM 99
Preliminary
Timing Diagrams
Power Up
Notes:
1. After VCC reaches VCC(Min.), wait 200 µs with CS1# high. Then the device gets into the normal operation.
Notes:
1. After VCC reaches VCC(Min.), wait 200 µs with CS2 low. Then the device gets into the normal operation.
Functional Description
Legend:X = Don’t care (must be low or high state).
Figure 23. Power Up 1 (CS1# Controlled)
Figure 24. Power Up 2 (CS2 Controlled)
Mode CS1# CS2 OE# WE# LB# UB# I/O1-8 I/O9-16 Power
Deselected H X X X X X High-Z High-Z Standby
Deselected X L X X X X High-Z High-Z Standby
Deselected X X X X H H High-Z High-Z Standby
Output Disabled L H H H L X High-Z High-Z Active
Outputs Disabled L H H H X L High-Z High-Z Active
Lower Byte Read L H L H L H DOUT High-Z Active
Upper Byte Read L H L H H L High-Z DOUT Active
Word Read L H L H L L DOUT DOUT Active
Lower Byte Write L H X L L H DIN High-Z Active
Upper Byte Write L H X L H L High-Z DIN Active
Word Write L HXLLL D
IN DIN Active
Min. 200 s
VCC
CS
1#
CS2
VCC(Min)
Normal Operation Power Up Mode
Min. 200 s
VCC
CS1#
CS2
VCC(Min)
Normal Operation Power Up Mode
100 Type 2 pSRAM pSRAM_Type02_15A0 May 3, 2004
Preliminary
Absolute Maximum Ratings
Notes:
1. Stresses greater than those listed under "Absolute Maximum Ratings" section may cause permanent damage to the device.
Functional operation should be restricted to be used under recommended operating condition. Exposure to absolute
maximum rating conditions longer than 1 second may affect reliability.
DC Recommended Operating Conditions
Notes:
1. TA=-40 to 85°C, otherwise specified.
2. Overshoot: VCC+1.0V in case of pulse width 20ns.
3. Undershoot: -1.0V in case of pulse width 20ns.
4. Overshoot and undershoot are sampled, not 100% tested.
Capacitance (Ta = 25°C, f = 1 MHz)
Note: This parameter is sampled periodically and is not 100% tested.
DC and Operating Characteristics
Common
Item Symbol Ratings Unit
Voltage on any pin relative to V
SS
V
IN ,
V
OUT
-0.2 to V
CC
+0.3V V
Voltage on V
CC
supply relative to V
SS
V
CC
-0.2 to 3.6V V
Power Dissipation P
D
1.0 W
Operating Temperature T
A
-40 to 85 °C
Symbol Parameter Min Ty p Max Unit
V
CC
Power Supply Voltage 2.7 2.9 3.1
V
V
SS
Ground 0 0 0
V
IH
Input High Voltage 2.2 V
CC
+ 0.3 (Note 2)
V
IL
Input Low Voltage -0.2 (Note 3) 0.6
Symbol Parameter Test Condition Min Max Unit
C
IN
Input Capacitance V
IN
= 0V 8 pF
C
OIO
Input/Output Capacitance V
OUT
= 0V 10 pF
Item Symbol Test Conditions Min Ty p Max Unit
Input Leakage Current I
LI
V
IN
=V
SS
to V
CC
-1 1 µA
Output Leakage Current I
LO
CS1#=V
IH
or CS2=V
IL
or OE#=V
IH
or WE#=V
IL
or
LB#=UB#=V
IH
, V
IO
=V
SS
to V
CC
-1 1 µA
Output Low Voltage V
OL
I
OL
=2.1mA 0.4 V
Output High Voltage V
OH
I
OH
=-1.0mA 2.4 V
May 3, 2004 pSRAM_Type02_15A0 Type 2 pSRAM 101
Preliminary
16M pSRAM
Notes:
1. Standby mode is supposed to be set up after at least one active operation after power up. ISB1 is measure after 60ms from
the time when standby mode is set up.
32M pSRAM
Notes:
1. Standby mode is supposed to be set up after at least one active operation after power up. ISB1 is measure after 60ms from
the time when standby mode is set up.
Item Symbol Test Conditions Min Ty p Max Unit
Average Operating
Current
I
CC1
Cycle time=1µs, 100% duty, I
IO
=0mA,
CS1#
0.2V, LB#
0.2V and/or UB#
0.2V,
CS2
V
CC
-0.2V, V
IN
0.2V or V
IN
VCC-0.2V
7 mA
I
CC2
Async
Cycle time=Min, I
IO
=0mA, 100% duty,
CS1#=V
IL
, CS2=V
IH
LB#=V
IL
and/or UB#=V
IL
,
V
IN
=V
IH
or V
IL
30 mA
Page
Cycle time=t
RC
+3t
PC
, I
IO
=0mA, 100% duty,
CS1#=V
IL
, CS2=V
IH
LB#=V
IL
and/or UB#=V
IL
,
V
IN
-V
IH
or V
IL
35 mA
Standby Current (CMOS) I
SB1
(Note 1)
Other inputs=0-VCC
1. CS1#
V
CC
- 0.2, CS2
V
CC
- 0.2V (CS1#
controlled) or
2. 0V
CS2
0.2V (CS2 controlled)
80 mA
Item Symbol Test Conditions Min Ty p Max Unit
Average Operating
Current
I
CC1
Cycle time=1µs, 100% duty, I
IO
=0mA,
CS1#
0.2V, LB#
0.2V and/or UB#
0.2V,
CS2
V
CC
-0.2V, V
IN
0.2V or V
IN
VCC-0.2V
7 mA
I
CC2
Async
Cycle time=Min, I
IO
=0mA, 100% duty,
CS1#=V
IL
, CS2=V
IH
LB#=V
IL
and/or UB#=V
IL
,
V
IN
=V
IH
or V
IL
35 mA
Page
Cycle time=t
RC
+3t
PC
, I
IO
=0mA, 100% duty,
CS1#=V
IL
, CS2=V
IH
LB#=V
IL
and/or UB#=V
IL
,
V
IN
-V
IH
or V
IL
40 mA
Standby Current (CMOS) I
SB1
(Note 1)
Other inputs=0-VCC
1. CS1#
V
CC
- 0.2, CS2
V
CC
- 0.2V (CS1#
controlled) or
2. 0V
CS2
0.2V (CS2 controlled)
100 mA
102 Type 2 pSRAM pSRAM_Type02_15A0 May 3, 2004
Preliminary
64M pSRAM
Notes:
1. Standby mode is supposed to be set up after at least one active operation after power up. ISB1 is measure after 60ms from
the time when standby mode is set up.
AC Operating Conditions
Test Conditions (Test Load and Test Input/Output Reference)
Input pulse level: 0.4 to 2.2V
Input rising and falling time: 5ns
Input and output reference voltage: 1.5V
Output load (See Figure 25): CL=50pF
Note: Including scope and jig capacitance.
Item Symbol Test Conditions Min Ty p Max Unit
Average Operating
Current
I
CC1
Cycle time=1µs, 100% duty, I
IO
=0mA,
CS1#
0.2V, LB#
0.2V and/or UB#
0.2V,
CS2
V
CC
-0.2V, V
IN
0.2V or V
IN
VCC-0.2V
TBD mA
I
CC2
Async
Cycle time=Min, I
IO
=0mA, 100% duty,
CS1#=V
IL
, CS2=V
IH
LB#=V
IL
and/or UB#=V
IL
,
V
IN
=V
IH
or V
IL
TBD mA
Page
Cycle time=t
RC
+3t
PC
, I
IO
=0mA, 100% duty,
CS1#=V
IL
, CS2=V
IH
LB#=V
IL
and/or UB#=V
IL
,
V
IN
-V
IH
or V
IL
TBD mA
Standby Current (CMOS) I
SB1
(Note 1)
Other inputs=0-VCC
1. CS1#
V
CC
- 0.2, CS2
V
CC
- 0.2V (CS1#
controlled) or
2. 0V
CS2
0.2V (CS2 controlled)
TBD mA
Figure 25. Output Load
CL
Dout
May 3, 2004 pSRAM_Type02_15A0 Type 2 pSRAM 103
Preliminary
ACC Characteristics (Ta = -40°C to 85°C, VCC = 2.7 to 3.1 V)
Notes:
1. tWP (min)=70ns for continuous write operation over 50 times.
Symbol Parameter
Speed Bins
Unit
70ns
Min Max
Read
t
RC
Read Cycle Time 70 ns
t
AA
Address Access Time 70 ns
t
CO
Chip Select to Output 70 ns
t
OE
Output Enable to Valid Output 35 ns
t
BA
UB#, LB# Access Time 70 ns
t
LZ
Chip Select to Low-Z Output 10 ns
t
BLZ
UB#, LB# Enable to Low-Z Output 10 ns
t
OLZ
Output Enable to Low-Z Output 5 ns
t
HZ
Chip Disable to High-Z Output 025 ns
t
BHZ
UB#, LB# Disable to High-Z Output 025 ns
t
OHZ
Output Disable to High-Z Output 025 ns
t
OH
Output Hold from Address Change 5 ns
t
PC
Page Cycle Time 25 ns
t
PA
Page Access Time 20 ns
Write
t
WC
Write Cycle Time 70 ns
t
CW
Chip Select to End of Write 60 ns
t
AS
Address Set-up Time 0 ns
t
AW
Address Valid to End of Write 60 ns
t
BW
UB#, LB# Valid to End of Write 60 ns
t
WP
Write Pulse Width 55 (Note 1) ns
t
WR
Write Recovery Time 0 ns
t
WHZ
Write to Output High-Z 025 ns
t
DW
Data to Write Time Overlap 30 ns
t
DH
Data Hold from Write Time 0 ns
t
OW
End Write to Output Low-Z 5 ns
104 Type 2 pSRAM pSRAM_Type02_15A0 May 3, 2004
Preliminary
Timing Diagrams
Read Timings
Notes:
1. Address Controlled, CS1#=OE#=VIL, CS2=WE#=VIH, UB# and/or LB#=VIL.
Notes:
1. WE#=VIH.
Notes:
Figure 26. Timing Waveform of Read Cycle(1)
Figure 27. Timing Waveform of Read Cycle(2)
Figure 28. Timing Waveform of Read Cycle(2)
Address
Data Out Previous Data Valid Data Valid
tAA
tRC
tOH
Data Valid
High-Z
tRC
tOH
tAA
tBA
tOE
tOLZ
tBLZ
tLZ
tOHZ
tBHZ
tHZ
tCO
Address
UB#, LB#
OE#
Data out
CS1#
CS2
Data
Valid Data
Valid Data
Valid
Data
Valid
Valid
Address Valid
Address
Valid
Address
Valid
Address
Valid
Address
t
PC
t
PA
High Z
A1~A0
DQ15~DQ0
OE#
t
OHZ
t
OE
t
CO
t
AA
CS1#
CS2
Address
1)
May 3, 2004 pSRAM_Type02_15A0 Type 2 pSRAM 105
Preliminary
1. 16Mb: A2 ~ A19, 32Mb: A2 ~ A20, 64Mb: A2 ~ A21.
tHZ and tOHZ are defined as the time at which the outputs achieve the open circuit conditions and are not referenced to
output voltage levels.
At any given temperature and voltage condition, tHZ(Max.) is less than tLZ(Min.) both for a given device and from device
to device interconnection.
tOE(max) is met only when OE# becomes enabled after tAA(max).
If invalid address signals shorter than min. tRC are continuously repeated for over 4µs, the device needs a normal read
timing (tRC) or needs to sustain standby state for min. tRC at least once in every 4µs.
Write Timings
Figure 29. Write Cycle #1 (WE# Controlled)
Figure 30. Write Cycle #2 (CS1# Controlled)
Address
CS1#
Data Undefined
UB#, LB#
WE#
Data in
Data out
tWC
tCW tWR
tAW
tBW
tWP
tAS tDH
tDW
tWHZ tOW
High-Z High-Z
Data Valid
CS2
Address
Data Valid
UB#, LB#
WE#
Data in
Data out High-Z
tWC
tCW
tAW
tBW
tWP
tDH
tDW
tWR
tAS
CS1#
CS2
106 Type 2 pSRAM pSRAM_Type02_15A0 May 3, 2004
Preliminary
Notes:
1. A write occurs during the overlap(tWP) of low CS1# and low WE#. A write begins when CS1# goes low and WE# goes low
with asserting UB# or LB# for single byte operation or simultaneously asserting UB# and LB# for double byte operation. A
write ends at the earliest transition when CS1# goes high and WE# goes high. The tWP is measured from the beginning of
write to the end of write.
2. tCW is measured from the CS1# going low to the end of write.
3. tAS is measured from the address valid to the beginning of write.
4. tWR is measured from the end of write to the address change. tWR is applied in case a write ends with CS1# or WE# going
high.
Figure 31. Timing Waveform of Write Cycle(3) (CS2 Controlled)
Figure 32. Timing Waveform of Write Cycle(4) (UB#, LB# Controlled)
Address
Data Valid
UB#, LB#
WE#
Data in
Data out High-Z
tWC
tCW
tAW
tBW
tWP(1)
tDH
tDW
tWR
tAS
CS1#
CS2
Address
Data Valid
UB#, LB#
WE#
Data in
Data out High-Z
t
WC
t
CW
t
BW
t
WP
t
DH
t
DW
t
WR
t
AW
t
AS
CS1#
CS2
February 25, 2004 pSRAM_EtronTech_06A2 107
Preliminary
pSRAM Type 3
16 Megabit (1M x 16) CMOS Pseudo SRAM
Features
Organized as 1M words by 16 bits
Fast Cycle Time: 70 ns
Standby Current: 100 µA
Deep power-down Current: 10 µA (Memory cell data invalid)
Byte data control: LB# (DQ0 - 7), UB# (DQ8 - 15)
Compatible with low-power SRAM
Single Power Supply Voltage: 3.0V±0.3V
Description
pSRAM Type 3 currently includes only a 16M bit device, organized as 1M words
by 16 bits. It is designed with advanced CMOS technology specified RAM featur-
ing low-power static RAM-compatible function and pin configuration. This device
operates from a single power supply. Advanced circuit technology provides both
high speed and low power. It is automatically placed in low-power mode when
CS1# or both UB# and LB# are asserted high or CS2 is asserted low. There are
three control inputs. CS1# and CS2 are used to select the device, and output en-
able (OE#) provides fast memory access. Data byte control pins (LB#,UB#)
provide lower and upper byte access. This device is well suited to various micro-
processor system applications where high speed, low power and battery backup
are required.
Pin Description
A0 – A19 = Address Inputs
DQ0 – DQ15 = Data Inputs/Outputs
CE1# = Chip Enable
CE2 = Deep Power Down
OE# = Output Enable
WE# = Write Control
LB# = Lower Byte Control
UB# = Upper Byte Control
VCC = Power Supply
VSS = Ground
108 pSRAM_EtronTech_06A2 February 25, 2004
Preliminary
Operation Mode
Note: X=don’t care. H=logic high. L=logic low.
Absolute Maximum Ratings (see Note)
Note: Absolute maximum DC requirements contains stress ratings only. Functional operation at the absolute maximum
limits is not implied or guaranteed. Extended exposure to maximum ratings may affect device reliability.
DC Characteristics
Notes:
1. Overshoot: VCC + 2.0V in case of pulse width
20ns
2. Undershoot: -2.0V in case of pulse width
20ns
3. Overshoot and undershoot are sampled, not 100% tested.
MODE CE1# CE2 OE# WE# LB# UB# DQ0 to DQ7 DQ8 to DQ15 POWER
Deselect H H X X X X High-Z High-Z Standby
Deselect X L X X X X High-Z High-Z Deep Power Down
Deselect L H X X H H High-Z High-Z Standby
Output Disabled L H H H L X High-Z High-Z Active
Output Disabled L H H H X L High-Z High-Z Active
Lower Byte Read L H L H L H D-out High-Z Active
Upper Byte Read L H L H H L High-Z D-out Active
Word Read L H L H L L D-out D-out Active
Lower Byte Write L H X L L H D-in High-Z Active
Upper Byte Write L H X L H L High-Z D-in Active
Word Write L H X L L L D-in D-in Active
SYMBOL RATING VALUE UNIT
V
CC
Supply Voltage -0.2 to +3.6 V
V
IN
Input Voltages -0.2 to V
CC
+ 0.3 V
V
IN
, V
OUT
Output and output Voltages -2.0 to +3.6 V
I
SH
Output short circuit current 100 mA
P
D
Power Dissipation 1 W
Ta bl e 3 0 . DC Recommended Operating Conditions
SYMBOL PARAMET ER MIN TYP. MAX UNIT
V
DD
Power Supply Voltage 2.7 3.0 3.3
V
V
SS
Ground 0 - 0
V
IH
Input High Voltage 2.2 - V
CC
+ 0.2 (Note 1)
V
IL
Input Low Voltage -0.2 (Note 2) - +0.6
February 25, 2004 pSRAM_EtronTech_06A2 109
Preliminary
AC Characteristics
Ta b l e 3 1 . DC Characteristics (TA = -25°C to 85°C, VDD = 2.6 to 3.3V)
SYMBOL PARAME TER TEST CONDITION MIN MAX UNIT
I
IL
Input Leakage Current V
IN
= V
SS
to V
DD
-1 1
µ
A
I
LO
Output Leakage Current
V
IO
= V
SS
to V
DD
CE1# = V
IH
, CE2 = V
IL
or
OE# = V
IH
or WE# = V
IL
-1 1
µ
A
I
CC1
Operating Current @ Min Cycle Time
Cycle time = Min., 100% duty,
I
IO
= 0mA, CE1# = V
IL
, CE2 = V
IH
,
V
IN
= V
IH
or V
IL
-35 mA
I
CC2
Operating Current @ Max Cycle Time
Cycle time = 1
µ
s, 100% duty
I
IO
= 0mA, CE1#
0.2V,
CE2
V
DD
-0.2V, V
IN
0.2V
or V
IN
V
DD
-0.2V
- 5 mA
I
SB1
Standby Current (CMOS)
CE1# = V
DD –
0.2V and
CE2 = V
DD –
0.2V,
Other inputs = V
SS
~ V
CC
-100
µ
A
I
SBD
Deep Power-down
CE2
0.2V, Other inputs =
V
SS
~ V
CC
10
µ
A
V
OL
Output Low Voltage I
OL
= 2.1mA -0.4 V
V
OH
Output High Voltage I
OH
= -1.0mA 2.4 - V
Ta b l e 3 2 . AC Characteristics and Operating Conditions (TA = -25°C to 85°C, VDD = 2.6 to 3.3V)
Cycle Symbol Parameter
70
UnitMin Max
Read
t
RC
Read Cycle Time 70 -ns
t
AA
Address Access Time -70 ns
t
CO1
Chip Enable (CE#1) Access Time -70 ns
t
CO2
Chip Enable (CE2) Access Time -70 ns
t
OE
Output Enable Access Time -35 ns
t
BA
Data Byte Control Access Time -70 ns
t
LZ
Chip Enable Low to Output in Low-Z 10 -ns
t
OLZ
Output Enable Low to Output in Low-Z 5 - ns
t
BLZ
Data Byte Control Low to Output in Low-Z 10 -ns
t
HZ
Chip Enable High to Output in High-Z -25 ns
t
OHZ
Output Enable High to Output in High-Z -25 ns
t
BHZ
Data Byte Control High to Output in High-Z -25 ns
t
OH
Output Data Hold Time 10 -ns
110 pSRAM_EtronTech_06A2 February 25, 2004
Preliminary
Write
t
WC
Write Cycle Time 70 -ns
t
WP
Write Pulse Width 50 -ns
t
AW
Address Valid to End of Write 60 -ns
t
CW
Chip Enable to End of Write 60 -ns
t
BW
Data Byte Control to End of Write 60 -ns
t
AS
Address Set-up Time 0 - ns
t
WR
Write Recovery Time 0 - ns
t
WZH
WE#
Low to Output High-Z
-20 ns
t
OW
WE#
High to Output in High-Z
5 - ns
t
DW
Data to Write Overlap 35 -ns
t
DH
Data Hold Time 0 - ns
t
WEH
WE# High Time 510 ns
Ta b l e 3 3 . AC Test Conditions
Parameter Condition
Output load 50 pF
+
1 TTL Gate
Input pulse level 0.4 V, 2.4
Timing measurements 0.5
×
V
CC
t
R
, t
F
5 ns
Note: Including scope and jig capacitance
Figure 33. AC Test Loads
Table 32. AC Characteristics and Operating Conditions (TA = -25°C to 85°C, VDD = 2.6 to 3.3V) (Continued)
Cycle Symbol Parameter
70
UnitMin Max
CL
RL
= 50
Z0
= 50
DOUT VL
= 1.5 V
= 50 pF (see Note)
February 25, 2004 pSRAM_EtronTech_06A2 111
Preliminary
Timing Diagrams
Figure 34. State Diagram
Ta b l e 3 4 . Standby Mode Characteristics
Power Mode Memory Cell Data Standby Current (µA) Wait Time (µs)
Standby Valid 100 0
Deep Power Down Invalid 10 200
Note: CE1# = OE# = VIL, CE2 = WE# = VIH, UB# and/or LB# = VIL
Figure 35. Read Cycle 1—Addressed Controlled
CE2=VIH CE2=VIL
CE1# = VIH or VIL,
CE2=VIH
CE2=VIL
CE2=VIH,
CE1# =VIH or
UB#, LB# =VIH
CE1# =VIL, CE2=VIH,
UB# & LB# or/and LB# = VIL
Power
on
Initial State
(Wait 200 µs)
e
Deep Powe r
Down Mode
Standby
Mode
Powe r Up Sequence
Deep Power Down Exit Sequence
Active
Deep Power Down Entry Sequence
tRC
tOH tOH
Previous Data Valid Data Valid
tA
A
Address
Data Out
112 pSRAM_EtronTech_06A2 February 25, 2004
Preliminary
Note: CE2 = WE# = VIH
Figure 36. Read Cycle 2—CS1# Controlled
Notes:
1. CE2 = VIH
2. CE2 = WE# = VIH
Figure 37. Write Cycle 1—WE# Controlled
tRC
tOH
tA
A
tOLZ
High-Z
tOHZ
tBHZ
tHZ
Data Valid
High-Z
Address
CE1#
UB#, LB#
OE#
Data Out
tLZ
tCO
tBA
tBLZ
tOE
tWC
tWR
tAW
tWP
High-Z High-Z
Data Valid
tDH
Data Undefined
tDW
tOW
tWHZ
Address
CE1#
UB#, LB#
WE#
Data In
Data Out
tCW
tBW
tAS
February 25, 2004 pSRAM_EtronTech_06A2 113
Preliminary
Notes:
1. CE2 = VIH
2. CE2 = WE# = VIH
Figure 38. Write Cycle 2—CS1# Controlled
Notes:
1. CE2 = VIH
2. CE2 = WE# = VIH
Figure 39. Write Cycle3—UB#, LB# Controlled
tWC
tAW
Data Valid
tDH
tDW
Address
CE1#
UB#, LB#
WE#
Data In
High-Z
Data Out
tAS
tCW
tWR
tBW
tWP
tWC
tWR
tAW
t
WP
Data Valid
tDH
tDW
Address
CE1#
UB#, LB#
WE#
Data In
High-Z
Data Out
tCW
tBW
tAS
114 pSRAM_EtronTech_06A2 February 25, 2004
Preliminary
Figure 40. Deep Power-down Mode
Figure 41. Power-up Mode
Note: The S71JL064HA0 Model 61 has a timing that is not supported at read operation. Data will be lost if your system
has multiple invalid address signal shorter than tRC during over 15
µ
s at the read operation shown above.
Figure 42. Abnormal Timing
Normal Operation Normal Operation
1µs
Suspend
~
~~
~
Wake Up
Deep Power
Down Mode
200 µs
CE2
Mode
CE1#
~
~
200 s
VCC
CE2
CE1#
µ
< tRC
CE1#
WE#
Address
> 15µs
April 26, 2004 pSRAM_Type06_14_A0 pSRAM Type 6 115
Preliminary
pSRAM Type 6
2M Word by 16-bit Cmos Pseudo Static RAM (32M Density)
4M Word by 16-bit Cmos Pseudo Static RAM (64M Density)
Features
Single power supply voltage of 2.6 to 3.3 V
Direct TTL compatibility for all inputs and outputs
Deep power-down mode: Memory cell data invalid
Page operation mode:
Page read operation by 8 words
Logic compatible with SRAM R/W () pin
Standby current
Standby = 70 µA (32M)
Standby = 100 µA (64M)
Deep power-down Standby = 5 µA
Access Times
Pin Description
32M
64M
Access Time 70 ns
CE1# Access Time 70 ns
OE# Access Time 25 ns
Page Access Time 30 ns
Pin Name Description
A
0
to A
21
Address Inputs
A0 to A2 Page Address Inputs
I/O1 to I/O16 Data Inputs/Outputs
CE1# Chip Enable Input
CE2 Chip select Input
WE# Write Enable Input
OE# Output Enable Input
LB#,UB# Data Byte Control Inputs
V
DD
Power Supply
GND Ground
NC Not Connection
116 pSRAM Type 6 pSRAM_Type06_14_A0 April 26, 2004
Preliminary
Functional Description
Legend:L = Low-level Input (VIL), H = High-level Input (VIH), X = VIL or VIH, High-Z = High Impedance.
Absolute Maximum Ratings
DC Recommended Operating Conditions (Ta = -40°C to 85°C)
Note: VIH (Max) VDD = 1.0 V with 10 ns pulse width. VIL (Min) -1.0 V with 10 ns pulse width.
DC Characteristics (Ta = -40°C to 85°C, VDD = 2.6 to 3.3 V) (See Note 3 to 4)
Mode CE1# CE2 OE# WE# LB# UB# Address I/O1-8 I/O9-16 Power
Read (Word) L H L H L L X DOUT DOUT IDDO
Read (Lower Byte) L H L H L H X DOUT High-Z IDDO
Read (Upper Byte) L H L H H L X High-Z DOUT IDDO
Write (Word) L H X L L L X DIN DIN IDDO
Write (Lower Byte) LHX L LHX D
IN Invalid IDDO
Write (Upper Byte) L H X L H L X Invalid DIN IDDO
Outputs Disabled L H H H X X X High-Z High-Z IDDO
Standby H H X X X X X High-Z High-Z IDDO
Deep Power-down Standby H L X X X X X High-Z High-Z IDDSD
Symbol Rating Value Unit
V
DD
Power Supply Voltage -1.0 to 3.6 V
V
IN
Input Voltage -1.0 to 3.6 V
V
OUT
Output Voltage -1.0 to 3.6 V
T
opr
Operating Temperature -40 to 85 °C
T
strg
Storage Temperature -55 to 150 °C
P
D
Power Dissipation 0.6 W
I
OUT
Short Circuit Output Current 50 mA
Symbol Parameter Min Ty p Max Unit
V
DD
Power Supply Voltage 2.6 2.75 3.3
VV
IH
Input High Voltage 2.0 V
DD
+ 0.3 (Note)
V
IL
Input Low Voltage -0.3 (Note) 0.4
Symbol Parameter Test Condition Min Ty p . Max Unit
I
IL
Input Leakage
Current V
IN
= 0 V to V
DD
-1.0 +1.0 µA
I
LO
Output Leakage
Current Output disable, V
OUT
= 0 V to V
DD
-1.0 +1.0 µA
V
OH
Output High Voltage I
OH
= - 0.5 mA 2.0 ¾ V V
April 26, 2004 pSRAM_Type06_14_A0 pSRAM Type 6 117
Preliminary
Capacitance (Ta = 25°C, f = 1 MHz)
Note: This parameter is sampled periodically and is not 100% tested.
AC Characteristics and Operating Conditions
(Ta = -40°C to 85°C, VDD = 2.6 to 3.3 V) (See Note 5 to 11)
V
OL
Output Low Voltage I
OL
= 1.0 mA 0.4 V
I
DDO1
Operating Current CE1#= V
IL
, CE2 = V
IH
, I
OUT
= 0
mA, t
RC
= min
ET5UZ8A-43DS 40
mA
ET5VB5A-43DS 50
I
DDO2
Page Access
Operating Current
CE1#= V
IL
, CE2 = V
IH
, I
OUT
= 0 mA
Page add. cycling, t
RC
= min 25 mA
I
DDS
Standby
Current(MOS)
CE1# = V
DD
- 0.2 V,
CE2 = V
DD
- 0.2 V
ET5UZ8A-43DS 70 mA
ET5VB5A-43DS 100 µA
I
DDSD
Deep Power-down
Standby Current CE2 = 0.2 V 5 µA
Symbol Parameter Test Condition Max Unit
C
IN
Input Capacitance V
IN
= GND 10 pF
C
OUT
Output Capacitance V
OUT
= GND 10 pF
Symbol Parameter Min Max Unit
t
RC
Read Cycle Time 70 10000 ns
t
ACC
Address Access Time 70 ns
t
CO
Chip Enable (CE1#) Access Time 70 ns
t
OE
Output Enable Access Time 25 ns
t
BA
Data Byte Control Access Time 25 ns
t
COE
Chip Enable Low to Output Active 10 ns
t
OEE
Output Enable Low to Output Active 0 ns
t
BE
Data Byte Control Low to Output Active 0 ns
t
OD
Chip Enable High to Output High-Z 20 ns
t
ODO
Output Enable High to Output High-Z 20 ns
t
BD
Data Byte Control High to Output High-Z 20 ns
t
OH
Output Data Hold Time 10 ns
t
PM
Page Mode Time 70 10000 ns
t
PC
Page Mode Cycle Time 30 ns
t
AA
Page Mode Address Access Time 30 ns
t
AOH
Page Mode Output Data Hold Time 10 ns
t
WC
Write Cycle Time 70 10000 ns
Symbol Parameter Test Condition Min Typ. Max Unit
118 pSRAM Type 6 pSRAM_Type06_14_A0 April 26, 2004
Preliminary
AC Test Conditions
t
WP
Write Pulse Width 50 ns
t
CW
Chip Enable to End of Write 70 ns
t
BW
Data Byte Control to End of Write 60 ns
t
AW
Address Valid to End of Write 60 ns
t
AS
Address Set-up Time 0 ns
t
WR
Write Recovery Time 0 ns
t
CEH
Chip Enable High Pulse Width 10 ns
t
WEH
Write Enable High Pulse Width 6 ns
t
ODW
WE# Low to Output High-Z 20 ns
t
OEW
WE# High to Output Active 0ns
t
DS
Data Set-up Time 30 ns
t
DH
Data Hold Time 0 ns
t
CS
CE2 Set-up Time 0 ns
t
CH
CE2 Hold Time 300 µs
t
DPD
CE2 Pulse Width 10 ms
t
CHC
CE2 Hold from CE1# 0 ns
t
CHP
CE2 Hold from Power On 30 µs
Parameter Condition
Output load 30 pF + 1 TTL Gate
Input pulse level V
DD
- 0.2 V, 0.2 V
Timing measurements V
DD
x 0.5
Reference level V
DD
x 0.5
t
R
, t
F
5 ns
Symbol Parameter Min Max Unit
April 26, 2004 pSRAM_Type06_14_A0 pSRAM Type 6 119
Preliminary
Timing Diagrams
Read Timings
Figure 43. Read Cycle
tACC
tOD
tOH
VALID DATA OUT
tOE
tBE
tOEE
tBD
Hi-Z Hi-Z
tCO
Fix-H
tBA
tCOE
INDETERMINATE
tODO
tRC
Address
A0 to A20(32M)
A0 to A21(64M)
CE1#
CE2
OE#
WE#
UB#, LB#
DOUT
I/O1 to I/O16
120 pSRAM Type 6 pSRAM_Type06_14_A0 April 26, 2004
Preliminary
Figure 44. Page Read Cycle (8 Words Access)
t
PM
t
PC
t
RC
t
AOH
Fix-H
Hi-Z Hi-Z
t
BE
D
OUT
t
ACC
t
COE
t
CO
t
OE
t
BA
t
OEE
t
PC
t
AOH
t
PC
D
OUT
t
OD
t
OH
t
BD
t
ODO
t
AA
* Maximum 8 words
D
OUT
t
AOH
D
OUT
t
AA
t
AA
Address
A0 to A2
Address
A
3 to A20(32M)
A
3 to A21(64M)
CE1#
CE2
OE#
WE#
UB#, LB#
D
OUT
I/O1 to I/O16
April 26, 2004 pSRAM_Type06_14_A0 pSRAM Type 6 121
Preliminary
Write Timings
Figure 45. Write Cycle #1 (WE# Controlled) (See Note 8)
UB#
D
IN
I/O1 to I/O16
D
OUT
I/O1 to I/O16
CE2
CE1#
WE#
Address
A
0 to A20
A
0 to
(32M)
A21(64M)
t
WC
t
AS
t
BW
t
WR
VALID DATA IN
t
ODW
t
WP
t
DS
t
DH
t
OEW
(See Note 11)(S )ee Note 10 Hi-Z
t
CW
t
WR
t
WEH
t
AW
t
WR
t
CH
(See Note 9) (See Note 9)
, LB#
122 pSRAM Type 6 pSRAM_Type06_14_A0 April 26, 2004
Preliminary
Deep Power-down Timing
Power-on Timing
Figure 46. Write Cycle #2 (CE# Controlled) (See Note 8)
Figure 47. Deep Power Down Timing
Figure 48. Power-on Timing
t
WC
t
WP
t
AS
t
CW
t
WR
VALID DATA IN
t
ODW
t
DS
t
DH
t
COE
Hi-Z Hi-Z
t
AW
t
WR
t
CEH
t
BW
t
BE
t
WR
t
CH
(See Note 9)
Address
A0 to A20
A0 to
(32M)
A21(64M)
WE#
CE1#
CE2
UB#, LB#
D
OUT
I/O1 to I/O16
D
IN
I/O1 to I/O16
tCS
tDPD
tCH
CE1#
CE2
tCHC
tCHP
tCH
VDD min
VDD
CE1#
CE2
April 26, 2004 pSRAM_Type06_14_A0 pSRAM Type 6 123
Preliminary
Provisions of Address Skew
Read
In case multiple invalid address cycles shorter than tRC min sustain over 10 µs in
an active status, at least one valid address cycle over tRC min is required during
10µs.
Write
In case multiple invalid address cycles shorter than tWC min sustain over 10 µs in
an active status, at least one valid address cycle over tWC min is required during
10 µs.
Notes:
1. Stresses greater than listed under "Absolute Maximum Ratings" section may cause permanent damage to the device.
2. All voltages are reference to GND.
3. IDDO depends on the cycle time.
4. IDDO depends on output loading. Specified values are defined with the output open condition.
5. AC measurements are assumed tR, tF = 5 ns.
6. Parameters tOD, tODO, tBD and tODW define the time at which the output goes the open condition and are not output voltage
reference levels.
7. Data cannot be retained at deep power-down stand-by mode.
8. If OE# is high during the write cycle, the outputs will remain at high impedance.
9. During the output state of I/O signals, input signals of reverse polarity must not be applied.
10. If CE1# or LB#/UB# goes LOW coincident with or after WE# goes LOW, the outputs will remain at high impedance.
11. If CE1# or LB#/UB# goes HIGH coincident with or before WE# goes HIGH, the outputs will remain at high impedance.
Figure 49. Read
Figure 50. Write
over 10µs
tRCmin
CE1#
WE#
A
ddress
tWPmin
tWCmin
CE1#
WE#
A
ddress
May 4, 2004 pSRAM_Type07_13_A0 pSRAM Type 7 125
Preliminary
pSRAM Type 7
16Mb (1M word x 16-bit)
32Mb (2M word x 16-bit)
64Mb (4M word x 16-bit)
CMOS 1M/2M/4M-Word x 16 bit Fast Cycle Random Access Memory with Low
Power SRAM Interface
Features
Asynchronous SRAM Interface
Fast Access Time
tCE = tAA = 60ns max (16M)
tCE = tAA = 65ns max (32M/64M)
8 words Page Access Capability
tPAA = 20ns max (32M/64M)
Low Voltage Operating Condition
VDD = +2.7V to +3.1V
Wide Operating Temperature
TA = -30°C to +85°C
Byte Control by LB and UB
Low Power Consumption
—IDDA1 = 20mA max (16M)
—IDDA1 = 30mA max (32M)
—IDDA1 =TBDmA max (64M)
IDDS1 = 100µA max (16M)
IDDS1 = 80µA max (32M)
IDDS1 = TBDµA max (64M)
Various Power Down mode
Sleep, 4M-bit Partial or 8M-bit Partial (32M)
Sleep, 8M-bit Partial or 16M-bit Partial (64M
Pin Description
Pin Name Description
A
21
to A
0
Address Input: A
19
to A
0
for 16M, A
20
to A
0
for 32M, A
21
to A
0
for 64M
CE1# Chip Enable (Low Active)
CE2# Chip Enable (High Active)
WE# Write Enable (Low Active)
OE# Output Enable (Low Active)
UB# Upper Byte Control (Low Active)
LB# Lower Byte Control (Low Active)
DQ
16
-
9
Upper Byte Data Input/Output
DQ
8
-
1
Lower Byte Data Input/Output
V
DD
Power Supply
126 pSRAM Type 7 pSRAM_Type07_13_A0 May 4, 2004
Preliminary
Functional Description
Legend:L = VIL, H = VIH, X can be either VIL or VIH, High-Z = High Impedance.
Notes:
1. Should not be kept this logic condition longer than 1ms. Please contact local Spansion representative for the relaxation of
1ms limitation.
2. Power Down mode can be entered from Standby state and all DQ pins are in High-Z state. Data retention depends on the
selection of Power Down Program, 16M has data retention in all modes except Power Down. Refer to POWER DOWN for the
detail.
3. Can be either VIL or VIH but must be valid before Read or Write.
4. OE# can be VIL during Write operation if the following conditions are satisfied:
(1) Write pulse is initiated by CE1# (refer to CE1# Controlled Write timing), or cycle time of the previous operation cycle is
satisfied.
(2) OE# stays VIL during Write cycle
Power Down (for 32M, 64M Only)
Power Down
The Power Down is low power idle state controlled by CE2. CE2 Low drives the
device in power down mode and maintains low power idle state as long as CE2 is
kept Low. CE2 High resumes the device from power down mode. These devices
have three power down mode. These can be programmed by series of read/write
operation. Each mode has following features.
V
SS
Ground
Mode CE2# CE1# WE# OE# LB# UB# A21-0 DQ8-1 DQ16-9
Standby (Deselect) H H X X X X X High-Z High-Z
Output Disable (Note 1)
HL
H H X X Note 3 High-Z High-Z
Output Disable (No Read)
HL
H H Valid High-Z High-Z
Read (Upper Byte) H L Valid High-Z Output Valid
Read (Lower Byte) L H Valid Output Valid High-Z
Read (Word) L L Valid Output Valid Output Valid
No Write
LH (Note 4)
H H Valid Invalid Invalid
Write (Upper Byte) H L Valid Invalid Input Valid
Write (Lower Byte) L H Valid Input Valid Invalid
Write (Word) L L Valid Input Valid Input Valid
Power Down L X X X X X X High-Z High-Z
32M 64M
Mode Retention Data Retention Address Mode Retention Data Retention Address
Sleep (default) No N/A Sleep (default) No N/A
4M Partial 4M bit 00000h to 3FFFFh 8M Partial 8M bit 00000h to 7FFFFh
8M Partial 8M bit 00000h to 7FFFFh 16M Partial 16M bit 00000h to FFFFFh
Pin Name Description
May 4, 2004 pSRAM_Type07_13_A0 pSRAM Type 7 127
Preliminary
The default state is Sleep and it is the lowest power consumption but all data will
be lost once CE2 is brought to Low for Power Down. It is not required to program
to Sleep mode after power-up.
Power Down Program Sequence
The program requires total 6 read/write operation with unique address. Between
each read/write operation requires that device be in standby mode. Following
table shows the detail sequence.
The first cycle is to read from most significant address (MSB).
The second and third cycle are to write back the data (RDa) read by first cycle.
If the second or third cycle is written into the different address, the program is
cancelled and the data written by the second or third cycle is valid as a normal
write operation.
The forth and fifth cycle is to write to MSB. The data of forth and fifth cycle is
don’t-care. If the forth or fifth cycle is written into different address, the program
is also cancelled but write data may not be wrote as normal write operation.
The last cycle is to read from specific address key for mode selection.
Once this program sequence is performed from a Partial mode to the other Partial
mode, the written data stored in memory cell array may be lost. So, it should per-
form this program prior to regular read/write operation if Partial mode is used.
Address Key
The address key has following format.
Cycle # Operation Address Data
1st Read 3FFFFFh (MSB) Read Data (RDa)
2nd Write 3FFFFFh RDa
3rd Write 3FFFFFh RDa
4th Write 3FFFFFh Don’t Care (X)
5th Write 3FFFFFh X
6th Read Address Key Read Data (RDb)
Mode Address
32M 64M A21 A20 A19 A18 - A0 Binary
Sleep (default) Sleep (default) 1 1 1 1 3FFFFFh
4M Partial N/A 1 1 0 1 37FFFFh
8M Partial 8M Partial 1 0 1 1 2FFFFFh
N/A 16M Partial 1 0 0 1 27FFFFh
128 pSRAM Type 7 pSRAM_Type07_13_A0 May 4, 2004
Preliminary
Absolute Maximum Ratings
WARNING: Semiconductor devices can be permanently damaged by application of stress (voltage, current, temperature,
etc.) in excess of absolute maximum ratings. Do not exceed these ratings.
Recommended Operating Conditions (See Warning Below)
Notes:
1. Maximum DC voltage on input and I/O pins are VDD+0.2V. During voltage transitions, inputs may positive overshoot to
VDD+1.0V for periods of up to 5 ns.
2. Minimum DC voltage on input or I/O pins are -0.3V. During voltage transitions, inputs may negative overshoot VSS to -1.0V
for periods of up to 5ns.
WARNING: Recommended operating conditions are normal operating ranges for the semiconductor device. All the de-
vice’s electrical characteristics are warranted when operated within these ranges.
Always use semiconductor devices within the recommended operating conditions. Operation outside these ranges may
adversely affect reliability and could result in device failure.
No warranty is made with respect to uses, operating conditions, or combinations not represented on the data sheet.
Users considering application outside the listed conditions are advised to contact their FUJITSU representative before-
hand.
Package Capacitance
Test conditions: TA = 25°C, f = 1.0 MHz
Item Symbol Value Unit
Voltage of V
DD
Supply Relative to V
SS
V
DD
-0.5 to +3.6 V
Voltage at Any Pin Relative to V
SS
V
IN
, V
OUT
-0.5 to +3.6 V
Short Circuit Output Current I
OUT
±50 mA
Storage temperature T
STG
-55 to +125 °C
Parameter Symbol Min Max Unit
Supply Voltage
V
DD
2.7 3.1 V
V
SS
0 0 V
High Level Input Voltage (Note 1) V
IH
V
DD
0.8 V
DD
+0.2 V
High Level Input Voltage (Note 1) V
IL
-0.3 V
DD
0.2 V
Ambient Temperature T
A
-30 85 °C
Symbol Description Te s t S e t u p Ty p Max Unit
C
IN1
Address Input Capacitance V
IN
= 0V 5 pF
C
IN2
Control Input Capacitance V
IN
= 0V 5 pF
C
IO
Data Input/Output Capacitance V
IO
= 0V 8 pF
May 4, 2004 pSRAM_Type07_13_A0 pSRAM Type 7 129
Preliminary
DC Characteristics (Under Recommended Conditions Unless Otherwise
Noted)
Notes:
1. All voltages are referenced to VSS.
2. DC Characteristics are measured after following POWER-UP timing.
3. IOUT depends on the output load conditions.
Parameter Symbol Test Conditions
16M 32M 64M
UnitMin. Max. Min. Max. Min. Max.
Input Leakage
Current I
LI
V
IN
= V
SS
to V
DD
-1.0 +1.0 -1.0 +1.0 -1.0 +1.0
µ
A
Output Leakage
Current I
LO
V
OUT
= V
SS
to V
DD
, Output
Disable -1.0 +1.0 -1.0 +1.0 -1.0 +1.0
µ
A
Output High
Voltage Level V
OH
V
DD
= V
DD
(min), I
OH
= –
0.5mA 2.2 2.4 2.4 V
Output Low
Voltage Level V
OL
I
OL
= 1mA 0.4 0.4 0.4 V
V
DD
Power Down
Current
I
DDPS
V
DD
= V
DD(26)
max.,
V
IN
= V
IH
or V
IL
,
CE2
0.2V
SLEEP 10 10 TBD
µ
A
I
DDP4
4M Partial N/A 40 N/A
µ
A
I
DDP8
8M Partial N/A 50 TBD
µ
A
I
DDP16
16M
Partial N/A N/A TBD
µ
A
V
DD
Standby
Current
I
DDS
V
DD
= V
DD(26)
max.,
V
IN
= V
IH
or V
IL
CE1 = CE2 = V
IH
1 1.5 TBD mA
I
DDS1
V
DD
= V
DD(26)
max.,
V
IN
0.2V or V
IN
V
DD
– 0.2V,
CE1 = CE2
V
DD
– 0.2V
100 80 TBD
µ
A
V
DD
Active
Current
I
DDA1
V
DD
= V
DD(26)
max.,
V
IN
= V
IH
or V
IL
,
CE1 = V
IL
and
CE2= V
IH
,
I
OUT
=0mA
t
RC
/ t
WC
=
minimum
20 30 TBD mA
I
DDA2
t
RC
/ t
WC
=
1
µ
s
3 3 TBD mA
V
DD
Page Read
Current I
DDA3
V
DD
= V
DD(26)
max., V
IN
= V
IH
or V
IL
,
CE1 = V
IL
and CE2= V
IH
,
I
OUT
=0mA, t
PRC
= min.
N/A 10 TBD mA
130 pSRAM Type 7 pSRAM_Type07_13_A0 May 4, 2004
Preliminary
AC Characteristics (Under Recommended Operating Conditions Unless
Otherwise Noted)
Read Operation
Notes:
1. Maximum value is applicable if CE#1 is kept at Low without change of address input of A3 to A21. If needed by system
operation, please contact local Spansion representative for the relaxation of 1µs limitation.
2. Address should not be changed within minimum tRC.
3. The output load 50pF.
4. The output load 5pF.
Parameter Symbol
16M 32M 64M
Unit NotesMin. Max. Min. Max.
Read Cycle Time t
RC
70 1000 65 1000 65 1000 ns 1, 2
CE1# Access Time t
CE
60 65 65 ns 3
OE# Access Time t
OE
40 40 40 ns 3
Address Access Time t
AA
60 65 65 ns 3, 5
LB# / UB# Access Time t
BA
30 30 30 ns 3
Page Address Access Time t
PAA
N/A 20 20 ns 3,6
Page Read Cycle Time t
PRC
N/A 20 1000 20 1000 ns 1, 6, 7
Output Data Hold Time t
OH
5 5 5 ns 3
CE1# Low to Output Low-Z t
CLZ
5 5 5 ns 4
OE# Low to Output Low-Z t
OLZ
0 0 0 ns 4
LB# / UB# Low to Output
Low-Z t
BLZ
0 0 0 ns 4
CE1# High to Output High-Z t
CHZ
20 20 20 ns 3
OE# High to Output High-Z t
OHZ
20 15 20 ns 3
LB# / UB# High to Output
High-Z t
BHZ
20 20 20 ns 3
Address Setup Time to CE1#
Low t
ASC
-5 –5 –5 ns
Address Setup Time to OE#
Low t
ASO
10 10 10 ns
Address Invalid Time t
AX
10 10 10 ns 5, 8
Address Hold Time from CE1#
High t
CHAH
-6 –6 –6 ns 9
Address Hold Time from OE#
High t
OHAH
-6 –6 –6 ns
WE# High to OE# Low Time
for Read t
WHOL
10 1000 12 12 ns 10
CE1# High Pulse Width t
CP
10 12 12 ns
May 4, 2004 pSRAM_Type07_13_A0 pSRAM Type 7 131
Preliminary
5. Applicable to A3 to A21 (32M and 64M) when CE1# is kept at Low.
6. Applicable only to A0, A1 and A2 (32M and 64M) when CE1# is kept at Low for the page address access.
7. In case Page Read Cycle is continued with keeping CE1# stays Low, CE1# must be brought to High within 4µs. In other
words, Page Read Cycle must be closed within 4µs.
8. Applicable when at least two of address inputs among applicable are switched from previous state.
9. tRC(min) and tPRC(min) must be satisfied.
10. If actual value of tWHOL is shorter than specified minimum values, the actual tAA of following Read may become longer by the
amount of subtracting actual value from specified minimum value.
132 pSRAM Type 7 pSRAM_Type07_13_A0 May 4, 2004
Preliminary
AC Characteristics
Write Operation
Notes:
1. Maximum value is applicable if CE1# is kept at Low without any address change. If the relaxation is needed by system
operation, please contact local Spansion representative for the relaxation of 1µs limitation.
2. Minimum value must be equal or greater than the sum of write pulse (tCW, tWP or tBW) and write recovery time (tWR).
3. Write pulse is defined from High to Low transition of CE1#, WE#, or LB#/UB#, whichever occurs last.
4. Applicable for byte mask only. Byte mask setup time is defined to the High to Low transition of CE1# or WE# whichever
occurs last.
5. Applicable for byte mask only. Byte mask hold time is defined from the Low to High transition of CE1# or WE# whichever
occurs first.
6. Write recovery is defined from Low to High transition of CE1#, WE#, or LB#/UB#, whichever occurs first.
7. tWPH minimum is absolute minimum value for device to detect High level. And it is defined at minimum VIH level.
8. If OE# is Low after minimum tOHCL, read cycle is initiated. In other words, OE# must be brought to High within 5ns after
CE1# is brought to Low. Once read cycle is initiated, new write pulse should be input after minimum tRC is met.
9. If OE# is Low after new address input, read cycle is initiated. In other word, OE# must be brought to High at the same time
or before new address valid. Once read cycle is initiated, new write pulse should be input after minimum tRC is met and data
bus is in High-Z.
Parameter Symbol
16M 32M 64M
Unit NotesMin. Max. Min. Max. Min. Max.
Write Cycle Time t
WC
70 1000 65 1000 65 1000 ns 1,2
Address Setup Time t
AS
0 0 0 ns 3
CE1# Write Pulse Width t
CW
45 40 40 ns 3
WE# Write Pulse Width t
WP
45 40 40 ns 3
LB#/UB# Write Pulse Width t
BW
45 40 40 ns 3
LB#/UB# Byte Mask Setup
Time t
BS
-5 –5 –5 ns 4
LB#/UB# Byte Mask Hold
Time t
BH
-5 –5 –5 ns 5
Write Recovery Time t
WR
0 0 0 ns 6
CE1# High Pulse Width t
CP
10 12 12 ns
WE# High Pulse Width t
WHP
7.5 1000 7.5 1000 7.5 1000 ns 7
LB#/UB# High Pulse Width t
BHP
10 1000 12 1000 12 1000 ns
Data Setup Time t
DS
15 12 12 ns
Data Hold Time t
DH
0 0 0 ns
OE# High to CE1# Low Setup
Time for Write t
OHCL
-5 –5 –5 ns 8
OE# High to Address Setup
Time for Write t
OES
0 0 0 ns 9
LB# and UB# Write Pulse
Overlap t
BWO
30 30 30 ns
May 4, 2004 pSRAM_Type07_13_A0 pSRAM Type 7 133
Preliminary
AC Characteristics
Power Down Parameters
Notes:
1. Applicable also to power-up.
2. Applicable when 4M and 8M Partial mode is programmed.
Other Timing Parameters
Notes:
1. Some data might be written into any address location if tCHWX(min) is not satisfied.
2. The Input Transition Time (tT) at AC testing is 5ns as shown in below. If actual tT is longer than 5ns, it may violate AC
specification of some timing parameters.
Parameter Symbol
16M 32M 64M
Unit NoteMin. Max. Min. Max. Min. Max.
CE2 Low Setup Time for Power Down Entry t
CSP
10 10 10 ns
CE2 Low Hold Time after Power Down Entry t
C2LP
80 65 65 ns
CE1# High Hold Time following CE2 High after Power
Down Exit [SLEEP mode only] t
CHH
300 300 300
µ
s 1
CE1# High Hold Time following CE2 High after Power
Down Exit [not in SLEEP mode] t
CHHP
N/A 1 1
µ
s 2
CE1# High Setup Time following CE2 High after
Power Down Exit t
CHS
0 0 0 ns 1
Parameter Symbol
16M 32M 64M
Unit NoteMin. Max. Min. Max. Min. Max.
CE1# High to OE# Invalid Time
for Standby Entry t
CHOX
10 10 10 ns
CE1# High to WE# Invalid
Time for Standby Entry t
CHWX
10 10 10 ns 1
CE2 Low Hold Time after
Power-up t
C2LH
N/A 50 50
µ
s
CE1# High Hold Time following
CE2 High after Power-up t
CHH
300 300 300
µ
s
Input Transition Time t
T
125 125 125 ns 2
134 pSRAM Type 7 pSRAM_Type07_13_A0 May 4, 2004
Preliminary
AC Characteristics
AC Test Conditions
AC Measurement Output Load Circuit
Symbol Description Te s t S e t u p Value Unit Note
V
IH
Input High Level V
DD
* 0.8 V
V
IL
Input Low Level V
DD
* 0.2 V
V
REF
Input Timing Measurement Level V
DD
* 0.5 V
t
T
Input Transition Time Between V
IL
and V
IH
5ns
Figure 51. AC Output Load Circuit
DEVICE
UNDER
TEST
VDD
VSS
OUT
0.1µF
50pF
May 4, 2004 pSRAM_Type07_13_A0 pSRAM Type 7 135
Preliminary
Timing Diagrams
Read Timings
Note: This timing diagram assumes CE2=H and WE#=H.
Note: This timing diagram assumes CE2=H and WE#=H.
Figure 52. Read Timing #1 (Basic Timing)
Figure 53. Read Timing #2 (OE# Address Access
tCE
VALID DATA OUTPUT
A
DDRESS
CE1#
DQ
(Output)
OE#
tCHZ
t
RC
tOLZ
tCHAH
tCP
ADDRESS VALID tASCtASC
tOHZ
tOH
tBHZ
LB#/ UB#
tOE
tBA
tBLZ
tCLZ
tAA
VALID DATA OUTPUT
A
DDRESS
CE1#
DQ
(Output)
tOHZ
tOE
tRC
tOLZ
ADDRESS VALID
VALID DATA OUTPUT
ADDRESS VALID
tRC
tOH tOH
OE#
t
Ax
Low
tAA tOHAH
tASO
LB#/UB#
136 pSRAM Type 7 pSRAM_Type07_13_A0 May 4, 2004
Preliminary
Note: This timing diagram assumes CE2=H and WE#=H.
Note: This timing diagram assumes CE2=H and WE#=H.
Figure 54. Read Timing #3 (LB#/UB# Byte Access)
Figure 55. Read Timing #4 (Page Address Access after CE1# Control Access
for 32M and 64M Only)
tAA
VALID DATA
OUTPUT
ADDRESS
DQ1-8
(Output)
UB# tBHZ
tBA
tRC
tBLZ
ADDRESS VALID
VALID DATA
OUTPUT
tBHZ
tOH
LB#
tAX
Low
tBA
tAx
DQ9-16
(Output)
tBLZ
tBA
tBLZ tOH
tBHZ
tOH
VALID DATA OUTPUT
C
E1#, OE#
VALID DATA OUTPUT
(Normal Access)
A
DDRESS
(A2-A0)
CE1#
DQ
(Output)
OE#
tCHZ
tCE
tRC
tCLZ
ADDRESS VALID
VALID DATA OUTPUT
(Page Access)
ADDRESS
VALID
tPRC
tOH tOH
tCHAH
tPAA
A
DDRESS
(A21-A3) ADDRESS VALID
tPAA
tOH
tPRC
tPAA
tPRC
tOH
ADDRESS
VALID ADDRESS
VALID
tRC
tASC
LB#/UB#
May 4, 2004 pSRAM_Type07_13_A0 pSRAM Type 7 137
Preliminary
Notes:
1. This timing diagram assumes CE2=H and WE#=H.
2. Either or both LB# and UB# must be Low when both CE1# and OE# are Low.
Write Timings
Note: This timing diagram assumes CE2=H.
Figure 56. Read Timing #5 (Random and Page Address Access for 32M and
64M Only)
Figure 57. Write Timing #1 (Basic Timing)
VALID DATA OUTPUT
(Normal Access)
A
DDRESS
(A2-A0)
CE1#
DQ
(Output)
OE#
tOE
tRC
tOLZ
tBLZ
tAA
VALID DATA OUTPUT
(Page Access)
ADDRESS
VALID
tPRC
tOH tOH
tRC
tPAA
A
DDRESS
(A21-A3) ADDRESS VALID
tAA
tOH
ADDRESS VALID
tRC
tPAA
tPRC
tOH
ADDRESS
VALID ADDRESS
VALID
tRC
tAxtAX
tBA
ADDRESS
VALID
Low
tASO
LB#/UB#
tAS
VALID DATA INPUT
A
DDRESS
CE1#
DQ
(Input)
WE#
tDHtDS
tWC
tWR
tWP
tCW
LB#, UB#
tAStBW
ADDRESS VALID
tAS
tAS
tWR
OE#
tOHCL
tAS
tAS
tWR
tCP
tWHP
tBHP
138 pSRAM Type 7 pSRAM_Type07_13_A0 May 4, 2004
Preliminary
Note:This timing diagram assumes CE2=H.
Note: This timing diagram assumes CE2=H and OE#=H.
Figure 58. Write Timing #2 (WE# Control)
Figure 59. Write Timing #3-1 (WE#/LB#/UB# Byte Write Control)
tAS
A
DDRESS
WE#
CE1#
tWC
tWRtWP
LB#, UB#
ADDRESS VALID
tAS tWRtWP
VALID DATA INPUT
DQ
(Input)
tDHtDS
OE#
tOES
tOHZ
tWC
VALID DATA INPUT
tDHtDS
Low
ADDRESS VALID
tOHAH
tWHP
tAS
A
DDRESS
WE#
CE1#
tWC
tWR
tWP
LB#
ADDRESS VALID
tAS
tWR
tWP
VALID DATA INPUT
DQ1-8
(Input)
tDHtDS
UB#
tWC
tDHtDS
Low
ADDRESS VALID
DQ9-16
(Input)
tBS tBH
tBS
tBH
tWHP
May 4, 2004 pSRAM_Type07_13_A0 pSRAM Type 7 139
Preliminary
Note: This timing diagram assumes CE2=H and OE#=H.
Note: This timing diagram assumes CE2=H and OE#=H.
Figure 60. Write Timing #3-2 (WE#/LB#/UB# Byte Write Control)
Figure 61. Write Timing #3-3 (WE#/LB#/UB# Byte Write Control)
tAS
A
DDRESS
WE#
CE1#
tWC
tWR
tBW
LB#
ADDRESS VALID
tAS
tWR
tBW
VALID DATA INPUT
DQ1-8
(Input)
tDHtDS
UB#
tWC
VALID DATA INPUT
tDHtDS
Low
ADDRESS VALID
DQ9-16
(Input)
tBS tBH
tBS tBH
tWHP
tAS
A
DDRESS
WE#
CE1#
tWC
tWRtBW
LB#
ADDRESS VALID
tAS tWRtBW
VALID DATA INPUT
DQ1-8
(Input)
tDHtDS
UB#
tWC
VALID DATA INPUT
tDHtDS
Low
ADDRESS VALID
DQ9-16
(Input)
tBS tBH
tBS tBH
tWHP
140 pSRAM Type 7 pSRAM_Type07_13_A0 May 4, 2004
Preliminary
Note: This timing diagram assumes CE2=H and OE#=H.
Read/Write Timings
Notes:
1. This timing diagram assumes CE2=H.
2. Write address is valid from either CE1# or WE# of last falling edge.
Figure 62. Write Timing #3-4 (WE#/LB#/UB# Byte Write Control)
Figure 63. Read/Write Timing #1-1 (CE1# Control)
tAS
A
DDRESS
WE#
CE1#
tWC
tWRtBW
LB#
ADDRESS VALID
tAS tWR
tBW
DQ1-8
(Input)
tDH
tDS
UB#
tWC
tDHtDS
Low
ADDRESS VALID
DQ9-16
(Input)
tDHtDS
tAS tWRtBW
tAS tWRtBW
tDHtDS
VALID
DATA INPUT VALID
DATA INPUT
VALID
DATA INPUT VALID
DATA INPUT
tBWO
tBWO
tBHP
tBHP
READ DATA OUTPUT
A
DDRESS
CE1#
DQ
WE#
tWC
tCW
OE#
tOHCL
UB#, LB#
tCHAH
tCP
WRITE ADDRESS
tAS
tRC
WRITE DATA INPUT
tDS
tCHZ
tOH
tCP
tCEtASC
READ ADDRESS
tWR tCHAH
tDH tCLZ tOH
May 4, 2004 pSRAM_Type07_13_A0 pSRAM Type 7 141
Preliminary
Notes:
1. This timing diagram assumes CE2=H.
2. OE# can be fixed Low during write operation if it is CE1# controlled write at Read-Write-Read sequence.
Notes:
1. This timing diagram assumes CE2=H.
2. CE1# can be tied to Low for WE# and OE# controlled operation.
Figure 64. Read / Write Timing #1-2 (CE1#/WE#/OE# Control)
Figure 65. Read / Write Timing #2 (OE#, WE# Control)
READ DATA OUTPUT
A
DDRESS
CE1#
DQ
WE#
tWC
tWP
OE#
tOHCL
UB#, LB#
tOE
tCHAH
tCP
WRITE ADDRESS
tAS
tRC
WRITE DATA INPUT
tDS
tCHZ
tOH
tCP
tCEtASC
READ ADDRESS
tWR tCHAH
tDH tOLZ tOH
READ DATA OUTPUT
READ DATA OUTPUT
A
DDRESS
CE1#
DQ
WE#
tWC
tWP
OE#
UB#, LB#
tOE
WRITE ADDRESS
tAS
tRC
WRITE DATA INPUT
tDS
tOHZ
tOH
tAA
READ ADDRESS
tWR
tDH tOLZ tOH
READ DATA OUTPUT
tOHZ
Low
tASO
tOHAH
tOES
tOHAH
tWHOL
142 pSRAM Type 7 pSRAM_Type07_13_A0 May 4, 2004
Preliminary
Notes:
1. This timing diagram assumes CE2=H.
2. CE1# can be tied to Low for WE# and OE# controlled operation.
Note: The tC2LH specifies after VDD reaches specified minimum level.
Figure 66. Read / Write Timing #3 (OE#, WE#, LB#, UB# Control)
Figure 67. Power-up Timing #1
READ DATA OUTPUT
A
DDRESS
CE1#
DQ
WE#
tWC
tBW
OE#
UB#, LB#
tBA
WRITE ADDRESS
tAS
tRC
WRITE DATA INPUT
tDS
tBHZ
tOH
tAA
READ ADDRESS
tDH tBLZ tOH
READ DATA OUTPUT
tBHZ
Low
tASO
tOHAHtOHAH
tOES
tWHOL
tWR
tC2LH
CE1#
V
DD
V
DD min
0V
CE2
tCHH
tCHS
May 4, 2004 pSRAM_Type07_13_A0 pSRAM Type 7 143
Preliminary
Note: The tCHH specifies after VDD reaches specified minimum level and applicable to both CE1# and CE2.
Note: This Power Down mode can be also used as a reset timing if POWER-UP timing above could not be satisfied and
Power-Down program was not performed prior to this reset.
Note: Both tCHOX and tCHWX define the earliest entry timing for Standby mode. If either of timing is not satisfied, it takes
tRC (min) period for Standby mode from CE1# Low to High transition.
Figure 68. Power-up Timing #2
Figure 69. Power Down Entry and Exit Timing
Figure 70. Standby Entry Timing after Read or Write
CE1#
VDD VDD min
0V
CE2
tCHH
tCSP
CE1#
Power Down Entry
CE2
tC2LP tCHH (tCHHP)
Power Down Mode Power Down Exit
tCHS
DQ High-Z
tCHOX
CE1#
OE#
WE#
Active (Read) Standby Active (Write) Standby
tCHWX
144 pSRAM Type 7 pSRAM_Type07_13_A0 May 4, 2004
Preliminary
Notes:
1. The all address inputs must be High from Cycle #1 to #5.
2. The address key must confirm the format specified in page 127. If not, the operation and data are not guaranteed.
3. After tCP following Cycle #6, the Power Down Program is completed and returned to the normal operation.
Figure 71. Power Down Program Timing (for 32M/64M Only)
ADDRESS
CE1#
DQ*3
WE#
tRC
OE#
LB#, UB#
RDa
MSB*1MSB*1MSB*1MSB*1MSB*1Key*2
tWC tWC tWC tWC tRC
tCP tCP tCP tCP tCP tCP*3
Cycle #1 Cycle #2 Cycle #3 Cycle #4 Cycle #5 Cycle #6
RDa RDa X X RDb
146 SRAM SRAM_Type01_02A0 June 15, 2004
Preliminary
SRAM
4/8 Megabit CMOS SRAM
Common Features
Process Technology: Full CMOS
Power Supply Voltage: 2.7~3.3V
Three state outputs
Notes:
1. UB#, LB# swapping is available only at x16. x8 or x16 select by BYTE# pin.
Pin Description
Version Density
Organization
(I
SB1
, Max.)
Standby
(I
CC2
, Max.) Operating Mode
F4Mb x8 or x16 (note 1) 10 µA 22 mA Dual CS, UB# / LB# (tCS)
G4Mb x8 or x16 (note 1) 10 µA 22 mA Dual CS, UB# / LB# (tCS)
C8Mb x8 or x16 (note 1) 15 µA 22 mA Dual CS, UB# / LB# (tCS)
D8Mb X16 TBD TBD Dual CS, UB# / LB# (tCS)
Pin Name Description I/O
CS1#, CS2 Chip Selects I
OE# Output Enable I
WE# Write Enable I
BYTE# Word (V
CC
)/Byte (V
SS
) Select I
A0~A17 (4M)
A0~A18 (8M) Address Inputs I
SA Address Input for Byte Mode I
I/O0~I/O15 Data Inputs/Outputs I/O
V
CC
Power Supply -
V
SS
Ground -
DNU Do Not Use -
NC No Connection -
June 15, 2004 SRAM_Type01_02A0 SRAM 147
Preliminary
Functional Description
4M Version F, 4M version G, 8M version C
Note: X means don’t care (must be low or high state).
Byte Mode
CS1# CS2 OE# WE# BYTE# SA LB# UB# IO
0~7
IO
8~15
Mode Power
H X X X X X X X High-Z High-Z Deselected Standby
X L X X X X X X High-Z High-Z Deselected Standby
X X X X X X H H High-Z High-Z Deselected Standby
L H H H V
CC
X L X High-Z High-Z Output Disabled Active
L H H H V
CC
X X L High-Z High-Z Output Disabled Active
L H L H V
CC
X L H D
out
High-Z Lower Byte Read Active
L H L H V
CC
X H L High-Z D
out
Upper Byte Read Active
L H L H V
CC
X L L D
out
D
out
Word Read Active
L H X L V
CC
X L H D
in
High-Z Lower Byte Write Active
L H X L V
CC
X H L High-Z D
in
Upper Byte Write Active
L H X L V
CC
X L L D
in
D
in
Word Write Active
CS1# CS2 OE# WE# BYTE# SA LB# UB# IO
0~7
IO
8~15
Mode Power
H X X X X X X X High-Z High-Z Deselected Standby
X L X X X X X X High-Z High-Z Deselected Standby
L H H H X X H H High-Z High-Z Deselected Standby
L H L L V
CC
X L X High-Z High-Z Output Disabled Active
L H X L V
CC
X X L High-Z High-Z Output Disabled Active
148 SRAM SRAM_Type01_02A0 June 15, 2004
Preliminary
Functional Description
8M Version D
Note: X means don’t care (must be low or high state).
Absolute Maximum Ratings (4M Version F)
Stresses greater than those listed under “Absolute Maximum Ratings” may cause permanent damage to the device. Functional
operation should be restricted to recommended operating condition. Exposure to absolute maximum rating conditions for
extended periods may affect reliability.
Absolute Maximum Ratings (4M Version G, 8M Version C, 8M Version D)
Stresses greater than those listed under “Absolute Maximum Ratings” may cause permanent damage to the device. Functional
operation should be restricted to recommended operating condition. Exposure to absolute maximum rating conditions for
extended periods may affect reliability.
CS1# CS2 OE# WE# LB# UB# IO
0~8
IO
9~16
Mode Power
H X X X X X High-Z High-Z Deselected Standby
X L X X X X High-Z High-Z Deselected Standby
X X X X H H High-Z High-Z Deselected Standby
L H H H L X High-Z High-Z Output Disabled Active
L H H H X L High-Z High-Z Output Disabled Active
L H L H L H D
out
High-Z Lower Byte Read Active
L H L H H L High-Z D
out
Upper Byte Read Active
L H L H L L D
out
D
out
Word Read Active
L H X L L H D
in
High-Z Lower Byte Write Active
L H X L H L High-Z D
in
Upper Byte Write Active
L H X L L L D
in
D
in
Word Write Active
Item Symbol Ratings Unit
Voltage on any pin relative to V
SS
V
IN
,V
OUT
-0.2 to V
CC
+0.3V V
Voltage on V
CC
supply relative to V
SS
V
CC
-0.2 to 4.0V V
Power Dissipation P
D
1.0 W
Operating Temperature T
A
-40 to 85
°
C
Item Symbol Ratings Unit
Voltage on any pin relative to V
SS
V
IN
,V
OUT
-0.2 to V
CC
+0.3V (Max. 3.6V) V
Voltage on V
CC
supply relative to V
SS
V
CC
-0.2 to 3.6V V
Power Dissipation P
D
1.0 W
Operating Temperature T
A
-40 to 85
°
C
June 15, 2004 SRAM_Type01_02A0 SRAM 149
Preliminary
DC Characteristics
Recommended DC Operating Conditions (Note 1)
Notes:
1. TA = -40 to 85
°
C, unless otherwise specified.
2. Overshoot: Vcc+1.0V in case of pulse width 20ns.
3. Undershoot: -1.0V in case of pulse width 20ns.
4. Overshoot and undershoot are sampled, not 100% tested.
Capacitance (f=1MHz, TA=25°C)
Note: Capacitance is sampled, not 100% tested
DC Operating Characteristics
Common
Item Symbol Min Ty p Max Unit
Supply voltage V
CC
2.7 3.0 3.3 V
Ground V
SS
0 0 0 V
Input high voltage V
IH
2.2 - V
CC
+0.2 (Note 2) V
Input low voltage V
IL
-0.2 (Note 3) -0.6 V
Item Symbol Test Condition Min Max Unit
Input capacitance C
IN
V
IN
=0V - 8pF
Input/Output capacitance C
IO
V
IO
=0V -10 pF
Item Symbol Test Conditions Min
Ty p
(Note) Max Unit
Input leakage current I
LI
V
IN
=V
SS
to V
CC
-1 - 1
µ
A
Output leakage current I
LO
CS1#=V
IH
or CS2=V
IL
or OE#=V
IH
or
WE#=V
IL
or LB#=UB#=V
IH
, V
IO
=V
ss
to V
CC
-1 - 1
µ
A
Output low voltage V
OL
I
OL
= 2.1mA - - 0.4 V
Output high voltage V
OH
I
OH
= -1.0mA 2.4 - - V
150 SRAM SRAM_Type01_02A0 June 15, 2004
Preliminary
DC Operating Characteristics
4M Version F
Note: Typical values are not 100% tested.
DC Operating Characteristics
4M Version G
Note: Typical values are not 100% tested.
Item Symbol Test Conditions Min
Ty p
(Note) Max Unit
Average operating current
I
CC1
Cycle time=1µs, 100% duty, I
IO
=0mA, CS1#
0.2V,
CS2
V
CC
-0.2V,
BYTE#=V
SS
or V
CC
, V
IN
0.2V or V
IN
VCC-0.2V, LB#
0.2V or/and UB#
0.2V
- - 3 mA
I
CC2
Cycle time=Min, I
IO
=0mA, 100% duty, CS1# = V
IL
,
CS2=V
IH
,
BYTE# = V
SS
or V
CC
, V
IN
=V
IL
or V
IH
, LB#
0.2V or/
and UB#
0.2V
- - 22 mA
Standby Current (CMOS) I
SB1
(Note)
CS1#
V
CC
-0.2V, CS2
V
CC
-0.2V (CS1# controlled)
or CS2
0.2V (CS2 controlled), BYTE# = V
SS
or V
CC
,
Other input =0~V
CC
-1.0
(Note) 10 µA
Item Symbol Test Conditions Min
Ty p
(Note) Max Unit
Average operating current
I
CC1
Cycle time=1µs, 100% duty, I
IO
=0mA, CS1#
0.2V,
CS2
V
CC
-0.2V,
BYTE#=V
SS
or V
CC
, V
IN
0.2V or V
IN
VCC-0.2V, LB#
0.2V or/and UB#
0.2V
- - 4 mA
I
CC2
Cycle time=Min, I
IO
=0mA, 100% duty, CS1# = V
IL
,
CS2=V
IH
,
BYTE# = V
SS
or V
CC
, V
IN
=V
IL
or V
IH
, LB#
0.2V or/
and UB#
0.2V
- - 22 mA
Standby Current (CMOS) I
SB1
(Note)
CS1#
V
CC
-0.2V, CS2
V
CC
-0.2V (CS1# controlled)
or CS2
0.2V (CS2 controlled), BYTE# = V
SS
or V
CC
,
Other input = 0~V
CC
-3.0
(Note) 10 µA
June 15, 2004 SRAM_Type01_02A0 SRAM 151
Preliminary
DC Operating Characteristics
8M Version C
Note: Typical values are not 100% tested.
DC Operating Characteristics
8M Version D
Note: Typical values are not 100% tested.
Item Symbol Test Conditions Min
Ty p
(Note) Max Unit
Average operating current
I
CC1
Cycle time=1µs, 100% duty, I
IO
=0mA, CS1#
0.2V,
CS2
V
CC
-0.2V,
BYTE#=V
SS
or V
CC
, V
IN
0.2V or V
IN
VCC-0.2V, LB#
0.2V or/and UB#
0.2V
- - 3 mA
I
CC2
Cycle time=Min, I
IO
=0mA, 100% duty, CS1# = V
IL
,
CS2=V
IH
,
BYTE# = V
SS
or V
CC
, V
IN
=V
IL
or V
IH
, LB#
0.2V or/
and UB#
0.2V
- - 22 mA
Standby Current (CMOS) I
SB1
(Note)
CS1#
V
CC
-0.2V, CS2
V
CC
-0.2V (CS1# controlled)
or CS2
0.2V (CS2 controlled), BYTE# = V
SS
or V
CC
,
Other input = 0~V
CC
- - 15 µA
Item Symbol Test Conditions Min
Ty p
(Note) Max Unit
Average operating current
I
CC1
Cycle time=1µs, 100% duty, I
IO
=0mA, CS1#
0.2V,
CS2
V
CC
-0.2V,
BYTE#=V
SS
or V
CC
, V
IN
0.2V or V
IN
VCC-0.2V, LB#
0.2V or/and UB#
0.2V
- - TBD mA
I
CC2
Cycle time=Min, I
IO
=0mA, 100% duty, CS1# = V
IL
,
CS2=V
IH
,
BYTE# = V
SS
or V
CC
, V
IN
=V
IL
or V
IH
, LB#
0.2V or/
and UB#
0.2V
- - TBD mA
Standby Current (CMOS) I
SB1
(Note)
CS1#
V
CC
-0.2V, CS2
V
CC
-0.2V (CS1# controlled)
or CS2
0.2V (CS2 controlled), BYTE# = V
SS
or V
CC
,
Other input = 0~V
CC
- - TBD µA
152 SRAM SRAM_Type01_02A0 June 15, 2004
Preliminary
AC Operating Conditions
Test Conditions
Test Load and Test Input/Output Reference
Input pulse level: 0.4 to 2.2V
Input rising and falling time: 5ns
Input and output reference voltage: 1.5V
Output load (See Figure 72): CL= 30pF+1TTL
Notes:
1. Including scope and jig capacitance.
2. R1=3070
, R2=3150
Ω.
3. VTM =2.8V.
AC Characteristics
Read/Write Characteristics (VCC=2.7-3.3V)
Figure 72. AC Output Load
Parameter List Symbol
Speed Bins
Units
70ns
Min Max
Read
Read cycle time t
RC
70 -ns
Address access time t
AA
-70 ns
Chip select to output t
CO1
, t
CO2
-70 ns
Output enable to valid output t
OE
-35 ns
LB#, UB# Access Time t
BA
-70 ns
Chip select to low-Z output t
LZ1
, t
LZ2
10 -ns
LB#, UB# enable to low-Z output t
BLZ
10 -ns
Output enable to low-Z output t
OLZ
5 - ns
Chip disable to high-Z output t
HZ1
, t
HZ2
025 ns
UB#, LB# disable to high-Z output t
BHZ
025 ns
Output disable to high-Z output t
OHZ
025 ns
Output hold from address change t
OH
10 -ns
VTM (note 3)
R1 (note 2)
CL (note 1)
R2 (note 2)
June 15, 2004 SRAM_Type01_02A0 SRAM 153
Preliminary
Data Retention Characteristics (4M Version F)
Notes:
1. CS1 controlled:CS1#
VCC-0.2V. CS2 controlled: CS2 0.2V.
2. Typical values are not 100% tested.
Write
Write cycle time t
WC
70 -ns
Chip select to end of write t
CW
60 -ns
Address set-up time t
AS
0 - ns
Address valid to end of write t
AW
60 -ns
LB#, UB# valid to end of write t
BW
60 -ns
Write pulse width t
WP
50 -ns
Write recovery time t
WR
0 - ns
Write to output high-Z t
WHZ
020 ns
Data to write time overlap t
DW
30 -ns
Data hold from write time t
DH
0 - ns
End write to output low-Z t
OW
5 - ns
Item Symbol Test Condition Min Ty p Max Unit
V
CC
for data retention V
DR
CS1#
V
CC
-0.2V (Note 1), V
IN
0V. BYTE# = V
SS
or V
CC
1.5 -3.3 V
Data retention current I
DR
V
CC
=3.0V, CS1#
V
CC
-0.2V (Note 1), V
IN
0V - 1.0
(Note 2) 10
µ
A
Data retention set-up time t
SDR
See data retention waveform
0 - -
ns
Recovery time t
RDR
t
RC
- -
Parameter List Symbol
Speed Bins
Units
70ns
Min Max
154 SRAM SRAM_Type01_02A0 June 15, 2004
Preliminary
Data Retention Characteristics (4M Version G)
Notes:
1. CS1 controlled:CS1#
VCC-0.2V. CS2 controlled: CS2 0.2V.
Data Retention Characteristics (8M Version C)
Notes:
1. CS1 controlled:CS1#
VCC-0.2V. CS2 controlled: CS2
0.2V.
Data Retention Characteristics (8M Version D)
Notes:
1. CS1 controlled:CS1#
VCC-0.2V. CS2 controlled: CS2
0.2V.
Timing Diagrams
Item Symbol Test Condition Min Ty p Max Unit
V
CC
for data retention V
DR
CS1#
V
CC
-0.2V (Note 1), V
IN
0V. BYTE# = V
SS
or V
CC
1.5 -3.3 V
Data retention current I
DR
V
CC
=1.5V, CS1#
V
CC
-0.2V (Note 1), V
IN
0V - - 3
µ
A
Data retention set-up time t
SDR
See data retention waveform
0 - -
ns
Recovery time t
RDR
t
RC
- -
Item Symbol Test Condition Min Ty p Max Unit
V
CC
for data retention V
DR
CS1#
V
CC
-0.2V (Note 1). BYTE# = V
SS
or V
CC
1.5 -3.3 V
Data retention current I
DR
V
CC
=3.0V, CS1#
V
CC
-0.2V (Note 1) - -15
µ
A
Data retention set-up time t
SDR
See data retention waveform
0 - -
ns
Recovery time t
RDR
t
RC
- -
Item Symbol Test Condition Min Ty p Max Unit
V
CC
for data retention V
DR
CS1#
V
CC
-0.2V (Note 1), BYTE# = V
SS
or V
CC
1.5 -3.3 V
Data retention current I
DR
V
CC
=3.0V, CS1#
V
CC
-0.2V (Note 1) - -TBD
µ
A
Data retention set-up time t
SDR
See data retention waveform
0 - -
ns
Recovery time t
RDR
t
RC
- -
Figure 73. Timing Waveform of Read Cycle(1) (Address Controlled, CS#1=OE#=VIL, CS2=WE#=VIH, UB#
and/or LB#=VIL)
tAA
tRC
tOH
Address
Data Out Previous Data Valid Data Valid
June 15, 2004 SRAM_Type01_02A0 SRAM 155
Preliminary
Notes:
1. tHZ and tOHZ are defined as the time at which the outputs achieve the open circuit conditions and are not referenced to
output voltage levels.
2. At any given temperature and voltage condition, tHZ(Max.) is less than tLZ(Min.) both for a given device and from
device to device interconnection.
Figure 74. Timing Waveform of Read Cycle(2) (WE#=VIH, if BYTE# is Low, Ignore UB#/LB# Timing)
Figure 75. Timing Waveform of Write Cycle(1) (WE# controlled, if BYTE# is Low, Ignore UB#/LB# Timing)
High-Z
t
RC
t
OH
t
AA
t
CO1
t
BA
t
OE
t
OLZ
t
BLZ
t
LZ
t
OHZ
t
BHZ
t
HZ
t
CO2
Address
CS1#
CS2
UB#, LB#
OE#
Data out Data Valid
tWC
tCW(2) tWR(4)
tAW
tBW
tWP(1)
tAS(3)
tDH
tDW
tWHZ tOW
High-Z High-Z
tCW(2)
Address
CS1#
CS2
UB#, LB#
WE#
Data in
Data out Data Undefined
Data Valid
156 SRAM SRAM_Type01_02A0 June 15, 2004
Preliminary
Figure 76. Timing Waveform of Write Cycle(2) (CS# controlled, if BYTE# is Low, Ignore UB#/LB# Timing)
Notes:
1. A write occurs during the overlap (tWP) of low CS1# and low WE#. A write begins when CS1# goes low and WE#
goes low with asserting UB# or LB# for single byte operation or simultaneously asserting UB# and LB# for double
byte operation. A write ends at the earliest transition when CS1# goes high and WE# goes high. The tWP is
measured from the beginning of write to the end of write.
2. tCW is measured from the CS1# going low to the end of write.
3. tAS is measured from the address valid to the beginning of write.
4. tWR is measured from the end of write to the address change. tWR applied in case a write ends as CS1# or WE#
going high.
Figure 77. Timing Waveform of Write Cycle(3) (UB#, LB# controlled)
High-Z High-Z
tWC
tCW(2)
tAW
tBW
tWP(1)
tDH
tDW
tWR(4)
tAS(3)
Address
CS1#
CS2
UB#, LB#
WE#
Data in
Data out
Data Valid
High-Z High-Z
tWC
tCW(2)
tBW
tWP(1)
tDH
tDW
tWR(4)
tAW
tAS(3)
tCW(2)
Address
CS1#
CS2
UB#, LB#
WE#
Data in
Data out
Data Valid
June 15, 2004 SRAM_Type01_02A0 SRAM 157
Preliminary
Figure 78. Data Retention Waveform
t
SDR
t
RDR
t
SDR
t
RDR
VCC
2.7V
2.2V
VDR
CS1#
GND
CS1# Controlled
CS2 Controlled
VCC
2.7V
VDR
0.4V
GND
CS2
CS1# VCC - 0.2V
Data Retention Mode
Data Retention Mode
CS2 0.2V
June 8, 2004 pSRAM_Type01_12_A0 pSRAM Type 1 96
Preliminary
pSRAM Type 1
4Mbit (256K Word x 16-bit)
8Mbit (512K Word x 16-bit)
16Mbit (1M Word x 16-bit)
32Mbit (2M Word x 16-bit)
64Mbit (4M Word x 16-bit)
Features
Fast Cycle Times
—T
ACC < 70 nS
—T
ACC < 65 nS
—T
ACC < 60 nS
—T
ACC < 55 nS
Very low standby current
—I
SB < 120 µA (64M and 32M)
—I
SB < 100 µA (16M)
Very low operating current
Icc < 25mA
Functional Description
Absolute Maximum Ratings
Mode CE# CE2/ZZ# OE# WE# UB# LB# Addresses I/O 1-8 I/O 9-16 Power
Read (word) L H L H L L X Dout Dout IACTIVE
Read (lower byte) L H L H H L X Dout High-Z IACTIVE
Read (upper byte) L H L H L H X High-Z Dout IACTIVE
Write (word) L H X L L L X Din Din IACTIVE
Write (lower byte) L H X L H L X Din Invalid IACTIVE
Write (upper byte) L H X L L H X Invalid Din IACTIVE
Outputs disabled L H H H X X X High-Z High-Z IACTIVE
Standby H H X X X X X High-Z High-Z ISTANDBY
Deep power down H L X X X X X High-Z High-Z IDEEP SLEEP
Item Symbol Ratings Units
Voltage on any pin relative to V
SS
Vin, Vout -0.2 to V
CC
+0.3 V
Voltage on V
CC
relative to V
SS
V
CC
-0.2 to 3.6 V
Power dissipation P
D
1 W
Storage temperature T
STG
-55 to 150 °C
Operating temperature T
A
-25 to 85 °C
97 pSRAM Type 1 pSRAM_Type01_12_A0 June 8, 2004
Preliminary
DC Characteristics (4Mb pSRAM Asynchronous)
Asynchronous
Performance Grade -70
Density 4Mb pSRAM
Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Max Units
VCC Power Supply 2.7 3.3 V
VIH Input High Level 1.4 Vccq VCC + 0.3 V
VIL Input Low Level -0.3 0.4 V
IIL
Input Leakage
Current Vin = 0 to VCC 0.5 µA
ILO
Output Leakage
Current
OE = VIH or
Chip Disabled 0.5 µA
VOH
Output High
Voltage
IOH = -1.0 mA
VIOH = -0.2 mA 0.8 Vccq
IOH = -0.5 mA
VOL
Output Low
Voltage
IOL = 2.0 mA
VIOL = 0.2 mA 0.2
IOL = 0.5 mA
IACTIVE
Operating
Current VCC = 3.3 V 25 mA
ISTANDBY Standby Current
VCC = 3.0 V 70
µA
VCC = 3.3 V
IDEEP
SLEEP
Deep Power
Down Current A
IPAR 1/4
1/4 Array PAR
Current A
IPAR 1/2
1/2 Array PAR
Current A
June 8, 2004 pSRAM_Type01_12_A0 pSRAM Type 1 98
Preliminary
DC Characteristics (8Mb pSRAM Asynchronous)
Asynchronous
Version B C
Performance Grade -55 -70 -70
Density 8Mb pSRAM 8Mb pSRAM 8Mb pSRAM
Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Max Units Min Max Units Min Max Units
VCC Power Supply 2.7 3.3 V 2.7 3.6 V 2.7 3.3 V
VIH Input High Level 2.2 VCC + 0.3 V 2.2 VCC + 0.3 V 1.4 VCC+0.3 V
VIL Input Low Level -0.3 0.6 V -0.3 0.6 V -0.3 0.4 V
IIL
Input Leakage
Current Vin = 0 to VCC 0.5 µA 0.5 µA 0.5 µA
ILO
Output Leakage
Current
OE = VIH or
Chip Disabled 0.5 µA 0.5 µA 0.5 µA
VOH Output High Voltage
IOH = -1.0 mA VCC-0.4
V
VCC-0.4
VVIOH = -0.2 mA 0.8 VCCQ
IOH = -0.5 mA
VOL Output Low Voltage
IOL = 2.0 mA 0.4
V
0.4
VVIOL = 0.2 mA 0.2
IOL = 0.5 mA
IACTIVE Operating Current VCC = 3.3 V 25 mA 23 mA 25 mA
ISTANDBY Standby Current
VCC = 3.0 V 60
µA
60
µA
60
µA
VCC = 3.3 V
IDEEP
SLEEP
Deep Power Down
Current A xµA xµA
IPAR 1/4
1/4 Array PAR
Current A xµA xµA
IPAR 1/2
1/2 Array PAR
Current A xµA xµA
99 pSRAM Type 1 pSRAM_Type01_12_A0 June 8, 2004
Preliminary
DC Characteristics (16Mb pSRAM Asynchronous)
Asynchronous
Performance Grade -55 -70
Density 16Mb pSRAM 16Mb pSRAM
Symbol Parameter Conditions Minimum Maximum Units Minimum Maximum Units
VCC Power Supply 2.7 3.6 V 2.7 3.6 V
VIH Input High Level 2.2 VCC + 0.3 V 2.2 VCC + 0.3 V
VIL Input Low Level -0.3 0.6 V -0.3 0.6 V
IIL Input Leakage Current Vin = 0 to VCC 0.5 µA 0.5 µA
ILO Output Leakage Current OE = VIH or Chip Disabled 0.5 µA 0.5 µA
VOH Output High Voltage
IOH = -1.0 mA VCC-0.4
V
VCC-0.4
VIOH = -0.2 mA
IOH = -0.5 mA
VOL Output Low Voltage
IOL = 2.0 mA 0.4
V
0.4
VIOL = 0.2 mA
IOL = 0.5 mA
IACTIVE Operating Current VCC = 3.3 V 25 mA 23 mA
ISTANDBY Standby Current
VCC = 3.0 V 100
µA
100
µA
VCC = 3.3 V
IDEEP SLEEP Deep Power Down Current x µA x µA
IPAR 1/4 1/4 Array PAR Current x µA x µA
IPAR 1/2 1/2 Array PAR Current x µA x µA
June 8, 2004 pSRAM_Type01_12_A0 pSRAM Type 1 100
Preliminary
DC Characteristics (16Mb pSRAM Page Mode)
Page Mode
Performance Grade -60 -65 -70
Density 16Mb pSRAM 16Mb pSRAM 16Mb pSRAM
Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Max Units Min Max Units Min Max Units
VCC Power Supply 2.7 3.3 V 2.7 3.3 V 2.7 3.3 V
VIH
Input High
Level 0.8 Vccq VCC + 0.2 V 0.8 Vccq VCC + 0.2 V 0.8 Vccq VCC + 0.2 V
VIL
Input Low
Level -0.2 0.2 Vccq V -0.2 0.2 Vccq V -0.2 0.2 Vccq V
IIL
Input Leakage
Current Vin = 0 to VCC A 1µA A
ILO
Output
Leakage
Current
OE = VIH or
Chip Disabled A 1µA 1µA
VOH
Output High
Voltage
IOH = -1.0 mA
VV VIOH = -0.2 mA
IOH = -0.5 mA 0.8 Vccq 0.8 Vccq 0.8 Vccq
VOL
Output Low
Voltage
IOL = 2.0 mA
VV VIOL = 0.2 mA
IOL = 0.5 mA 0.2 Vccq 0.2 Vccq 0.2 Vccq
IACTIVE
Operating
Current VCC = 3.3 V 25 mA 25 mA 25 mA
ISTANDBY
Standby
Current
VCC = 3.0 V
µA µA µA
VCC = 3.3 V 100 100 100
IDEEP
SLEEP
Deep Power
Down Current 10 µA 10 µA 10 µA
IPAR 1/4
1/4 Array PAR
Current 65 µA 65 µA 65 µA
IPAR 1/2
1/2 Array PAR
Current 80 µA 80 µA 80 µA
101 pSRAM Type 1 pSRAM_Type01_12_A0 June 8, 2004
Preliminary
DC Characteristics (32Mb pSRAM Page Mode)
Page Mode
Version C E
Performance Grade -65 -60 -65 -70
Density 32Mb pSRAM 32Mb pSRAM 32Mb pSRAM 32Mb pSRAM
Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Max Units Min Max Units Min Max Units Min Max Units
VCC
Power
Supply 2.7 3.6 V 2.7 3.3 V 2.7 3.3 V 2.7 3.3 V
VIH
Input High
Level 1.4 VCC +
0.2 V0.8 Vccq
VCC
+ 0.2 V 0.8 Vccq VCC
+ 0.2 V0.8
Vccq
VCC
+
0.2
V
VIL
Input Low
Level -0.2 0.4 V -0.2 0.2
Vccq V-0.2
0.2
Vccq V-0.2
0.2
Vccq V
IIL
Input
Leakage
Current
Vin = 0 to VCC 0.5 µA 1 µA 1 µA 1 µA
ILO
Output
Leakage
Current
OE = VIH or
Chip Disabled 0.5 µA 1 µA 1 µA 1 µA
VOH
Output High
Voltage
IOH = -1.0 mA
VV VV
IOH = -0.2 mA 0.8
Vccq
IOH = -0.5 mA 0.8 Vccq 0.8 Vccq 0.8
Vccq
VOL
Output Low
Voltage
IOL = 2.0 mA
VV VV
IOL = 0.2 mA 0.2
IOL = 0.5 mA 0.2
Vccq
0.2
Vccq
0.2
Vccq
IACTIVE
Operating
Current VCC = 3.3 V 25 mA 25 mA 25 mA 25 mA
ISTANDBY
Standby
Current
VCC = 3.0 V
µA µA µA µA
VCC = 3.3 V 100 120 120 100
IDEEP
SLEEP
Deep Power
Down
Current
10 µA 10 µA 10 µA 10 µA
IPAR 1/4
1/4 Array
PAR Current 65 µA 75 µA 75 µA 65 µA
IPAR 1/2
1/2 Array
PAR Current 80 µA 90 µA 90 µA 80 µA
June 8, 2004 pSRAM_Type01_12_A0 pSRAM Type 1 102
Preliminary
DC Characteristics (64Mb pSRAM Page Mode)
Timing Test Conditions
Page Mode
Performance Grade -70
Density 64Mb pSRAM
Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Max Units
VCC Power Supply 2.7 3.3 V
VIH Input High Level 0.8 Vccq VCC + 0.2 V
VIL Input Low Level -0.2 0.2 Vccq V
IIL
Input Leakage
Current Vin = 0 to VCC A
ILO
Output Leakage
Current
OE = VIH or
Chip Disabled A
VOH
Output High
Voltage
IOH = -1.0 mA
VIOH = -0.2 mA
IOH = -0.5 mA 0.8 Vccq
VOL
Output Low
Voltage
IOL = 2.0 mA
VIOL = 0.2 mA
IOL = 0.5 mA 0.2 Vccq
IACTIVE
Operating
Current VCC = 3.3 V 25 mA
ISTANDBY Standby Current
VCC = 3.0 V
µA
VCC = 3.3 V 120
IDEEP
SLEEP
Deep Power
Down Current 10 µA
IPAR 1/4
1/4 Array PAR
Current 65 µA
IPAR 1/2
1/2 Array PAR
Current 80 µA
Item
Input Pulse Level 0.1 V
CC
to 0.9 V
CC
Input Rise and Fall Time 5ns
Input and Output Timing Reference Levels 0.5 V
CC
Operating Temperature -25°C to +85°C
103 pSRAM Type 1 pSRAM_Type01_12_A0 June 8, 2004
Preliminary
Output Load Circuit
Power Up Sequence
After applying power, maintain a stable power supply for a minimum of 200 µs
after CE# > VIH.
Figure 79. Output Load Circuit
V
CC
30 pF
I/O
14.5K
14.5K
Output Load
June 8, 2004 pSRAM_Type01_12_A0 pSRAM Type 1 104
Preliminary
AC Characteristics (4Mb pSRAM Page Mode)
Asynchronous
Performance Grade -70
Density 4Mb pSRAM
3 Volt Symbol Parameter Min Max Units
Read
trc Read cycle time 70 ns
taa Address Access
Time 70 ns
tco Chip select to
output 70 ns
toe Output enable to
valid output 20 ns
tba UB#, LB# Access
time 70 ns
tlz Chip select to
Low-z output 10 ns
tblz UB#, LB# Enable
to Low-Z output 10 ns
tolz Output enable to
Low-Z output 5ns
thz Chip enable to
High-Z output 020ns
tbhz
UB#, LB#
disable to High-Z
output
020ns
tohz Output disable to
High-Z output 020ns
toh Output hold from
Address Change 10 ns
105 pSRAM Type 1 pSRAM_Type01_12_A0 June 8, 2004
Preliminary
Write
twc Write cycle time 70 ns
tcw Chipselect to end
of write 70 ns
tas Address set up
Time 0ns
taw Address valid to
end of write 70 ns
tbw UB#, LB# valid
to end of write 70 ns
twp Write pulse width 55 ns
twr Write recovery
time 0ns
twhz Write to output
High-Z 20 ns
tdw Data to write
time overlap 25 ns
tdh Data hold from
write time 0ns
tow End write to
output Low-Z 5
tow Write high pulse
width 7.5 ns
Other
tpc Page read cycle x
tpa Page address
access time x
twpc Page write cycle x
tcp Chip select high
pulse width x
Asynchronous
Performance Grade -70
Density 4Mb pSRAM
3 Volt Symbol Parameter Min Max Units
June 8, 2004 pSRAM_Type01_12_A0 pSRAM Type 1 106
Preliminary
AC Characteristics (8Mb pSRAM Asynchronous)
Asynchronous
Version B C
Performance Grade -55 -70 -70
Density 8Mb pSRAM 8Mb pSRAM 8Mb pSRAM
3 Volt Symbol Parameter Min Max Units Min Max Units Min Max Units
Read
trc Read cycle time 55 ns 70 ns 70 ns
taa Address Access
Time 55 ns 70 ns 70 ns
tco Chip select to
output 55 ns 70 ns 70 ns
toe Output enable to
valid output 30 ns 35 ns 20 ns
tba UB#, LB# Access
time 55 ns 70 ns 70 ns
tlz Chip select to
Low-z output 5 ns 5 ns 10 ns
tblz UB#, LB# Enable
to Low-Z output 5 ns 5 ns 10 ns
tolz Output enable to
Low-Z output 5ns5ns5ns
thz Chip enable to
High-Z output 020ns025ns020ns
tbhz
UB#, LB#
disable to High-Z
output
020ns025ns020ns
tohz Output disable to
High-Z output 020ns025ns020ns
toh Output hold from
Address Change 10 ns 10 ns 10 ns
107 pSRAM Type 1 pSRAM_Type01_12_A0 June 8, 2004
Preliminary
Write
twc Write cycle time 55 ns 70 ns 70 ns
tcw Chip select to
end of write 45 ns 55 ns 70 ns
tas Address set up
Time 0ns0ns0ns
taw Address valid to
end of write 45 ns 55 ns 70 ns
tbw UB#, LB# valid
to end of write 45 ns 55 ns 70 ns
twpWrite pulse width45ns55ns55ns
twr Write recovery
time 0ns0ns0ns
twhz Write to output
High-Z 25 ns 25 20 ns
tdw Data to write
time overlap 40 ns 40 ns 25 ns
tdh Data hold from
write time 0ns0ns0ns
tow End write to
output Low-Z 555
tow Write high pulse
width x x ns x x ns x x ns
Other
tpc Page read cycle x x x
tpa Page address
access time xxx
twpc Page write cycle x x x
tcp Chip select high
pulse width xxx
Asynchronous
Version B C
Performance Grade -55 -70 -70
Density 8Mb pSRAM 8Mb pSRAM 8Mb pSRAM
3 Volt Symbol Parameter Min Max Units Min Max Units Min Max Units
June 8, 2004 pSRAM_Type01_12_A0 pSRAM Type 1 108
Preliminary
AC Characteristics (16Mb pSRAM Asynchronous)
Asynchronous
Performance Grade -55 -70
Density 16Mb pSRAM 16Mb pSRAM
3 Volt Symbol Parameter Min Max Units Min Max Units
Read
trc Read cycle time 55 ns 70 ns
taa Address Access
Time 55 ns 70 ns
tco Chip select to
output 55 ns 70 ns
toe Output enable to
valid output 30 ns 35 ns
tba UB#, LB# Access
time 55 ns 70 ns
tlz Chip select to
Low-z output 5ns5ns
tblz UB#, LB# Enable
to Low-Z output 5ns5ns
tolz Output enable to
Low-Z output 5ns5ns
thz Chip enable to
High-Z output 025ns025ns
tbhz
UB#, LB#
disable to High-Z
output
025ns025ns
tohz Output disable to
High-Z output 025ns025ns
toh Output hold from
Address Change 10 ns 10 ns
109 pSRAM Type 1 pSRAM_Type01_12_A0 June 8, 2004
Preliminary
Write
twc Write cycle time 55 ns 70 ns
tcw Chipselect to end
of write 50 ns 55 ns
tas Address set up
Time 0ns0ns
taw Address valid to
end of write 50 ns 55 ns
tbw UB#, LB# valid
to end of write 50 ns 55 ns
twp Write pulse width 50 ns 55 ns
twr Write recovery
time 0ns0ns
twhz Write to output
High-Z 25 ns 25 ns
tdw Data to write
time overlap 25 ns 25 ns
tdh Data hold from
write time 0ns0ns
tow End write to
output Low-Z 55
tow Write high pulse
width xxnsxxns
Other
tpc Page read cycle x x
tpa Page address
access time xx
twpc Page write cycle x x
tcp Chip select high
pulse width xx
Asynchronous
Performance Grade -55 -70
Density 16Mb pSRAM 16Mb pSRAM
3 Volt Symbol Parameter Min Max Units Min Max Units
June 8, 2004 pSRAM_Type01_12_A0 pSRAM Type 1 110
Preliminary
AC Characteristics (16Mb pSRAM Page Mode)
Page Mode
Performance Grade -60 -65 -70
Density 16Mb pSRAM 16Mb pSRAM 16Mb pSRAM
3 Volt Symbol Parameter Min Max Units Min Max Units Min Max Units
Read
trc Read cycle time 60 20k ns 65 20k ns 70 20k ns
taa Address Access
Time 60 ns 65 ns 70 ns
tco Chip select to
output 60 ns 65 ns 70 ns
toe Output enable to
valid output 25 ns 25 ns 25 ns
tba UB#, LB# Access
time 60 ns 65 ns 70 ns
tlz Chip select to
Low-z output 10 ns 10 ns 10 ns
tblz UB#, LB# Enable
to Low-Z output 10 ns 10 ns 10 ns
tolz Output enable to
Low-Z output 5ns5ns5ns
thz Chip enable to
High-Z output 0 5 ns 0 5 ns 0 5 ns
tbhz
UB#, LB#
disable to High-Z
output
0 5 ns 0 5 ns 0 5 ns
tohz Output disable to
High-Z output 0 5 ns 0 5 ns 0 5 ns
toh Output hold from
Address Change 5ns5ns5ns
111 pSRAM Type 1 pSRAM_Type01_12_A0 June 8, 2004
Preliminary
Write
twc Write cycle time 60 20k ns 65 20k ns 70 20k ns
tcw Chipselect to end
of write 50 ns 60 ns 60 ns
tas Address set up
Time 0ns0ns0ns
taw Address valid to
end of write 50 ns 60 ns 60 ns
tbw UB#, LB# valid
to end of write 50 ns 60 ns 60 ns
twpWrite pulse width50ns50ns50ns
twr Write recovery
time 0ns0ns0ns
twhz Write to output
High-Z 5ns 5ns 5ns
tdw Data to write
time overlap 20 ns 20 ns 20 ns
tdh Data hold from
write time 0ns0ns0ns
tow End write to
output Low-Z 555
tow Write high pulse
width 7.5ns7.5ns7.5ns
Other
tpc Page read cycle 25 20k ns 25 20k ns 25 20k ns
tpa Page address
access time 25 ns 25 ns 25 ns
twpc Page write cycle 25 20k ns 25 20k ns 25 20k ns
tcp Chip select high
pulse width 10 ns 10 ns 10 ns
Page Mode
Performance Grade -60 -65 -70
Density 16Mb pSRAM 16Mb pSRAM 16Mb pSRAM
3 Volt Symbol Parameter Min Max Units Min Max Units Min Max Units
June 8, 2004 pSRAM_Type01_12_A0 pSRAM Type 1 112
Preliminary
AC Characteristics (32Mb pSRAM Page Mode)
Page Mode
Version C E
Performance Grade -65 -60 -65 -70
Density 32Mb pSRAM 32Mb pSRAM 32Mb pSRAM 32Mb pSRAM
3 Volt Symbol Parameter Min Max Units Min Max Units Min Max Units Min Max Units
Read
trc Read cycle time 65 20k ns 60 20k ns 65 20k ns 70 20k ns
taa Address Access
Time 65 ns 60 ns 65 ns 70 ns
tco Chip select to
output 65 ns 60 ns 65 ns 70 ns
toe Output enable to
valid output 20 ns 25 ns 25 ns 25 ns
tba UB#, LB# Access
time 65 ns 60 ns 65 ns 70 ns
tlz Chip select to
Low-z output 10 ns 10 ns 10 ns 10 ns
tblz UB#, LB# Enable
to Low-Z output 10 ns 10 ns 10 ns 10 ns
tolz Output enable to
Low-Z output 5 ns 5 ns 5 ns 5 ns
thz Chip enable to
High-Z output 020ns 0 5ns 0 5ns0 5ns
tbhz
UB#, LB#
disable to High-Z
output
020ns0 5ns 0 5ns0 5ns
tohz Output disable to
High-Z output 020ns 0 5ns 0 5ns 0 5ns
toh Output hold from
Address Change 5 ns 5 ns 5 ns 5 ns
113 pSRAM Type 1 pSRAM_Type01_12_A0 June 8, 2004
Preliminary
Write
twc Write cycle time 65 20k ns 60 20k ns 65 20k ns 70 20k ns
tcw Chipselect to end
of write 55 ns 50 ns 60 ns 60 ns
tas Address set up
Time 0 ns 0 ns 0 ns 0 ns
taw Address valid to
end of write 55 ns 50 ns 60 ns 60 ns
tbw UB#, LB# valid
to end of write 55 ns 50 ns 60 ns 60 ns
twp Write pulse width 55 20k ns 50 ns 50 ns 50 ns
twr Write recovery
time 0 ns 0 ns 0 ns 0 ns
twhz Write to output
High-Z 5 ns 5 ns 5 ns 5 ns
tdw Data to write
time overlap 25 ns 20 ns 20 ns 20 ns
tdh Data hold from
write time 0 ns 0 ns 0 ns 0 ns
tow End write to
output Low-Z 55 5 5
tow Write high pulse
width 7.5 ns 7.5 ns 7.5 ns 7.5 ns
Other
tpc Page read cycle 25 20k ns 25 20k ns 25 20k ns 25 20k ns
tpa Page address
access time 25 ns 25 ns 25 ns 25 ns
twpc Page write cycle 25 20k ns 25 20k ns 25 20k ns 25 20k ns
tcp Chip select high
pulse width 10 ns 10 ns 10 ns 10 ns
Page Mode
Version C E
Performance Grade -65 -60 -65 -70
Density 32Mb pSRAM 32Mb pSRAM 32Mb pSRAM 32Mb pSRAM
3 Volt Symbol Parameter Min Max Units Min Max Units Min Max Units Min Max Units
June 8, 2004 pSRAM_Type01_12_A0 pSRAM Type 1 114
Preliminary
AC Characteristics (64Mb pSRAM Page Mode)
Page Mode
Performance Grade -70
Density 64Mb pSRAM
3 Volt Symbol Parameter Min Max Units
Read
trc Read cycle time 70 20k ns
taa Address Access
Time 70 ns
tco Chip select to
output 70 ns
toe Output enable to
valid output 25 ns
tba UB#, LB# Access
time 70 ns
tlz Chip select to
Low-z output 10 ns
tblz UB#, LB# Enable
to Low-Z output 10 ns
tolz Output enable to
Low-Z output 5ns
thz Chip enable to
High-Z output 05ns
tbhz
UB#, LB#
disable to High-Z
output
05ns
tohz Output disable to
High-Z output 05ns
toh Output hold from
Address Change 5ns
115 pSRAM Type 1 pSRAM_Type01_12_A0 June 8, 2004
Preliminary
Timing Diagrams
Read Cycle
Write
twc Write cycle time 70 20k ns
tcw Chipselect to end
of write 60 ns
tas Address set up
Time 0ns
taw Address valid to
end of write 60 ns
tbw UB#, LB# valid
to end of write 60 ns
twp Write pulse width 50 20k ns
twr Write recovery
time 0ns
twhz Write to output
High-Z 5ns
tdw Data to write
time overlap 20 ns
tdh Data hold from
write time 0ns
tow End write to
output Low-Z 5
tow Write high pulse
width 7.5 ns
Other
tpc Page read cycle 20 20k ns
tpa Page address
access time 20 ns
twpc Page write cycle 20 20k ns
tcp Chip select high
pulse width 10 ns
Figure 80. Timing of Read Cycle (CE# = OE# = VIL, WE# = ZZ# = VIH)
Page Mode
Performance Grade -70
Density 64Mb pSRAM
3 Volt Symbol Parameter Min Max Units
A
ddress
Data Out
tRC
tAA
tOH
Data ValidPrevious Data Valid
June 8, 2004 pSRAM_Type01_12_A0 pSRAM Type 1 116
Preliminary
Figure 81. Timing Waveform of Read Cycle (WE# = ZZ# = VIH)
Address
LB#, UB#
OE#
Data Valid
tRC
tAA
tCO
tHZ
tOHZ
tBHZ
tOLZ
tOE
tLZ
High-Z
Data Out
tLB, tUB
tBLZ
CE#
117 pSRAM Type 1 pSRAM_Type01_12_A0 June 8, 2004
Preliminary
Figure 82. Timing Waveform of Page Mode Read Cycle (WE# = ZZ# = VIH)
Page Address (A4 - A20)
LB#, UB#
OE#
tAA
tCO
tHZ
tOHZ
tBHZ
tOLZ
tOE
High-Z
Data Out
tLB, tUB
tBLZ,
CE#
Word Address (A0 - A3)
tPA
tRC
tPGMAX
tPC
June 8, 2004 pSRAM_Type01_12_A0 pSRAM Type 1 118
Preliminary
Write Cycle
Figure 83. Timing Waveform of Write Cycle (WE# Control, ZZ# = VIH)
Figure 84. Timing Waveform of Write Cycle (CE# Control, ZZ# = VIH)
Addr es s
Dat a
In
CE#
Data Valid
t
WC
t
AW
t
CW
t
WR
t
WHZ
t
DH
High-Z
WE#
Da ta
Out
High-Z
t
OW
t
AS
t
WP
t
DW
t
BW
LB#, UB#
Ad dr es s
WE#
Data Valid
tWC
tAW
tCW
tWR
tDH
LB#, UB#
Dat a In
High-Z
tAS
tWP
tDW
tBW
Da ta Out
tWHZ
CE#
119 pSRAM Type 1 pSRAM_Type01_12_A0 June 8, 2004
Preliminary
Power Savings Modes (For 16M Page Mode, 32M and 64M Only)
There are several power savings modes.
Partial Array Self Refresh
Temperature Compensated Refresh (64M)
Deep Sleep Mode
Reduced Memory Size (32M, 16M)
The operation of the power saving modes ins controlled by the settings of bits
contained in the Mode Register. This definition of the Mode Register is shown in
Figure 86 and the various bits are used to enable and disable the various low
power modes as well as enabling Page Mode operation. The Mode Register is set
by using the timings defined in Figure xxx.
Partial Array Self Refresh (PAR)
In this mode of operation, the internal refresh operation can be restricted to a
16Mb, 32Mb, or 48Mb portion of the array. The array partition to be refreshed is
determined by the respective bit settings in the Mode Register. The register set-
tings for the PASR operation are defined in Table xxx. In this PASR mode, when
ZZ# is active low, only the portion of the array that is set in the register is re-
Figure 85. Timing Waveform of Page Mode Write Cycle (ZZ# = VIH)
Page A ddr ess
(A4 - A 20)
LB#, UB#
WE#
tWP
tCW
tDW
High-Z
Dat a Out
tLBW, tUBW
CE#
Wor d A ddr ess
(A0 - A3 )
tWC tPWC
tDH tPDW tPDH tPDW tPDH
tAS
tPGMAX
June 8, 2004 pSRAM_Type01_12_A0 pSRAM Type 1 120
Preliminary
freshed. The data in the remainder of the array will be lost. The PASR operation
mode is only available during standby time (ZZ# low) and once ZZ# is returned
high, the device resumes full array refresh. All future PASR cycles will use the
contents of the Mode Register that has been previously set. To change the ad-
dress space of the PASR mode, the Mode Register must be reset using the
previously defined procedures. For PASR to be activated, the register bit, A4Must
be set to a one (1) value, “PASR Enabled”. If this is the case, PASR will be acti-
vated 10 µs after ZZ# is brought low. If the A4 register bit is set equal to zero
(0), PASR will not be activated.
Temperature Compensated Refresh (for 64Mb)
In this mode of operation, the internal refresh rate can be optimized for the op-
eration temperature used and this can then lower standby current. The DRAM
array in the PSRAM must be refreshed internally on a regular basis. At higher
temperatures, the DRAM cell must be refreshed more often than at lower tem-
peratures. By setting the temperature of operation in the Mode Register, this
refresh rate can be optimized to yield the lowest standby current at the given op-
erating temperature. There are four different temperature settings that can be
programmed in to the PSRAM. These are defined in Figure 86.
Deep Sleep Mode
In this mode of operation, the internal refresh is turned off and all data integrity
of the array is lost. Deep Sleep is entered by bringing ZZ# low with the A4 reg-
ister bit set to a zero (0), “Deep Sleep Enabled”. If this is the case, Deep Sleep
will be entered 10 µs after ZZ# is brought low. The device will remain in this mode
as long as ZZ# remains low. If the A4 register bit is set equal to one (1), Deep
Sleep will not be activated.
Reduced Memory Size (for 32M and 16M)
In this mode of operation, the 32Mb PSRAM can be operated as a 8Mb or 16Mb
device. The mode and array size are determined by the settings in the VA register.
The VA register is set according to the following timings and the bit settings in
the tableAddress Patterns for RMS”. The RMS mode is enabled at the time of ZZ
transitioning high and the mode remains active until the register is updated. To
return to the full 32Mb address space, the VA register must be reset using the
previously defined procedures. While operating in the RMS mode, the unselected
portion of the array may not be used.
Other Mode Register Settings (for 64M)
The Page Mode operation can also be enabled and disabled using the Mode Reg-
ister. Register bit A7 controls the operation of Page Mode and setting this bit to a
one (1), enables Page Mode. If the register bit A7 is set to a zero (0), Page Mode
operation is disabled.
121 pSRAM Type 1 pSRAM_Type01_12_A0 June 8, 2004
Preliminary
Figure 86. Mode Register
Figure 87. Mode Register Update Timings (UB#, LB#, OE# are Don’t Care)
Deep Sleep Enable/Disable
0 = Deep Sleep Enabled
1 = Deep Sleep Disabled (default)
PAR Section
1 1 1 = Top 1/4 array
1 1 0 = Top 1/2 array
1 0 1 = Top 3/4 array
1 0 0 = No PAR
0 1 1 = Bottom 1/4 array
0 1 0 = Bottom 1/2 array
0 0 1 = Bottom 3/4 array
0 0 0 = Full array (default)
Reserved
Must set to all 0
A21 - A8 A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 A1 A0
Page Mode
0 = Page Mode Disabled (default)
1 = Page Mode Enabled
Tem p
Compensated
Refresh
1 0 = 15oC
0 1 = 45oC
0 0 = 70oC
1 1 = 85oC (default)
Array Mode
for ZZ#
0 = PAR (default)
1 = RMS
64 Mb 32 Mb / 16 Mb
Address
ZZ#
tWC
tAS
CE#
WE#
tZZWE
tAW
tWP
tWR
tCDZZ
June 8, 2004 pSRAM_Type01_12_A0 pSRAM Type 1 122
Preliminary
Figure 88. Deep Sleep Mode - Entry/Exit Timings
ZZ#
t
ZZMIN
t
CDZZ
t
R
CE#
123 pSRAM Type 1 pSRAM_Type01_12_A0 June 8, 2004
Preliminary
Mode Register Update and Deep Sleep Timings
Notes:
1. Minimum cycle time for writing register is equal to speed grade of product.
Address Patterns for PASR (A4=1) (64M)
Item Symbol Min Max Unit Note
Chip deselect to ZZ# low t
CDZZ
5ns
ZZ# low to WE# low t
ZZWE
10 500 ns
Write register cycle time t
WC
70/85 ns 1
Chip enable to end of write t
CW
70/85 ns 1
Address valid to end of write t
AW
70/85 ns 1
Write recovery time t
WR
0ns
Address setup time t
AS
0ns
Write pulse width t
WR
40 ns
Deep Sleep Pulse Width t
ZZMIN
10 µs
Deep Sleep Recovery t
R
150 µs
A2 A1 A0 Active Section Address Space Size Density
1 1 1 Top quarter of die 300000h-3FFFFFh 1Mb x 16 16Mb
1 1 0 Top half of die 200000h-3FFFFFh 2Mb x 16 32Mb
1 0 1 Reserved
1 0 0 No PASR None 0 0
0 1 1 Bottom quarter of die 000000h-0FFFFFh 1Mb x 16 16Mb
0 1 0 Bottom half of die 000000h-1FFFFFh 2Mb x 16 32Mb
0 0 1 Reserved
0 0 0 Full array 000000h-3FFFFFh 4Mb x 16 64Mb
June 8, 2004 pSRAM_Type01_12_A0 pSRAM Type 1 124
Preliminary
Deep ICC Characteristics (for 64Mb)
Address Patterns for PAR (A3= 0, A4=1) (32M)
Address Patterns for RMS (A3 = 1, A4 = 1) (32M)
Item Symbol Te s t Array Partition Ty p Max Unit
PASR Mode Standby Current I
PASR
V
IN
= V
CC
or 0V, Chip Disabled, t
A
= 85°C
None 10
µA
1/4 Array 75
1/2 Array 90
Full Array 120
Item Symbol Max Temperature Ty p Max Unit
Temperature Compensated Refresh Current I
TCR
15°C 50
µA
45°C 60
70°C 80
85°C 120
Item Symbol Te s t Ty p Max Unit
Deep Sleep Current I
ZZ
V
IN
= V
CC
or 0V, Chip in ZZ# mode, t
A
= 25°C 10 µA
A2 A1 A0 Active Section Address Space Size Density
0 1 1 One-quarter of die 000000h - 07FFFFh 512Kb x 16 8Mb
0 1 0 One-half of die 000000h - 0FFFFFh 1Mb x 16 16Mb
x 0 0 Full die 000000h - 1FFFFFh 2Mb x 16 32Mb
1 1 1 One-quarter of die 180000h - 1FFFFFh 512Kb x 16 8Mb
1 1 0 One-half of die 100000h - 1FFFFFh 1Mb x 16 16Mb
A2 A1 A0 Active Section Address Space Size Density
0 1 1 One-quarter of die 000000h - 07FFFFh 512Kb x 16 8Mb
0 1 0 One-half of die 000000h - 0FFFFFh 1Mb x 16 16Mb
1 1 1 One-quarter of die 180000h - 1FFFFFh 512Kb x 16 8Mb
1 1 0 One-half of die 100000h - 1FFFFFh 1Mb x 16 16Mb
125 pSRAM Type 1 pSRAM_Type01_12_A0 June 8, 2004
Preliminary
Low Power ICC Characteristics (32M)
Address Patterns for PAR (A3= 0, A4=1) (16M)
Address Patterns for RMS (A3 = 1, A4 = 1) (16M)
Low Power ICC Characteristics (16M)
Item Symbol Te s t Array Partition Ty p Max Unit
PAR Mode Standby Current I
PAR
V
IN
= V
CC
or 0V,
Chip Disabled, t
A
= 85
o
C
1/4 Array 65 µA
1/2 Array 80 µA
RMS Mode Standby Current I
RMSSB
V
IN
= V
CC
or 0V,
Chip Disabled, t
A
= 85
o
C
4Mb Device 40 µA
8Mb Device 50 µA
Deep Sleep Current I
ZZ
V
IN
= V
CC
or 0V,
Chip in ZZ mode, t
A
= 85
o
C10 µA
A2 A1 A0 Active Section Address Space Size Density
0 1 1 One-quarter of die 00000h - 0FFFFh 256Kb x 16 4Mb
0 1 0 One-half of die 00000h - 7FFFFh 512Kb x 16 8Mb
x 0 0 Full die 00000h - FFFFFh 1Mb x 16 162Mb
1 1 1 One-quarter of die C0000h - FFFFh 256Kb x 16 4Mb
1 1 0 One-half of die 80000h - 1FFFFFh 512Kb x 16 8Mb
A2 A1 A0 Active Section Address Space Size Density
0 1 1 One-quarter of die 00000h - 0FFFFh 256Kb x 16 4Mb
0 1 0 One-half of die 00000h - 7FFFFh 512Kb x 16 8Mb
1 1 1 One-quarter of die C0000h - FFFFFh 256Kb x 16 4Mb
1 1 0 One-half of die 80000h - FFFFFh 512Kb x 16 8Mb
Item Symbol Te s t Array Partition Ty p Max Unit
PAR Mode Standby Current I
PAR
V
IN
= V
CC
or 0V,
Chip Disabled, t
A
= 85
o
C
1/4 Array 65
µA
1/2 Array 80
RMS Mode Standby Current I
RMSSB
V
IN
= V
CC
or 0V,
Chip Disabled, t
A
= 85
o
C
4Mb Device 40
µA
8Mb Device 50
Deep Sleep Current I
ZZ
V
IN
= V
CC
or 0V,
Chip in ZZ# mode, t
A
= 85
o
C10 µA
July 16, 2004 S71PL254/127/064/032J_00_A4 126
Advance Information
Revision Summary
Revision A (May 3, 2004)
Initial release.
Revision A + 1 (May 6, 2004)
MCP Features
Corrected the high performance access times.
Connection Diagrams
Added reference points on all diagrams.
Ordering Information
Corrected package types.
Corrected the description of product family to Page Mode Flash memory.
pSRAM Type 1
Corrected the description of the 8Mb device to 512Kb Word x 16-bit.
pSRAM Type 6
Corrected the description of the 2Mb device to 128Kb Word x 16-bit.
Corrected the description of the 4Mb device to 256Kb Word x 16-bit.
Revision A + 2 (May 11, 2004)
General Description
Corrected the tables to reflect accurate device configurations.
Revision A + 3 (June 16, 2004)
Ordering Information
Corrected the Valid Combinations tables to reflect accurate device configurations.
SRAM
New section added.
Revision A4 (July 16, 2004)
Global Changes
Global Change of FASL to Spansion.
Global change to remove space between M and Mb callouts.
“32Mb Flash Memory” on page 2
Replaced “S71PL032J08-07” with “S71PL032J08-0B”.
Replaced “S71PL032JA0” with “S71PL032JA0-07”.
Added row with the following content: S71PL032JA0-08; 65; 16Mb pSRAM; 70;
pSRAM3; TLC056.
“64Mb Flash Memory” on page 2
Replaced
S71PL064J08-0K” with “S71PL064J08-0B”.
Replaced
S71PL064J08-0P” with “S71PL064J08-0U”.
Deleted “S71PL064J80-05” row.
Replaced
S71PL064JA0-07” with “S71PL064JA0-0K”.
Replaced
S71PL064JA0-0Z” with
127 S71PL254/127/064/032J_00_A4 July 16, 2004
Advance Information
Added row with the following content:
S71PL064JB0-07; 65; 32M pSRAM; 70; Psram
1; TLC056.
“32Mb Flash Memory” on page 2
Replaced
S71PL032JA0-08” with “S71PL032JA0-0F”.
“64Mb Flash Memory” on page 2
Replaced
S71PL032JA0-07” with “S71PL032JA0-0K”.
“128Mb Flash Memory” on page 2
Added row with the following content: S71PL127JB0-9; 65; 32M pSRAM; 70;
pSRAM; TLA064.
Replaced “S71PL127JB0-97” with
S71PL127JB0-9Z”.
Added row with the following content: S71PL127JC0-97; 65; 64M pSRAM; 70;
pSRAM1; TLA064.
Replaced
S71PL127JC0-9P” with “S71PL127JC0-9Z”.
In the S71Pl254JB0-TB row changed pSRAM type from
pSRAM3” to “pSRAM2”.
“256Mb Flash Memory (2xS29PL127J)” on page 3
Added row with the following content: S71PL254JB0-TB; 65; 32M pSRAM; 70;
pSRAM3; FTA084.
Added row with the following content:
S71PL254JC0-TB; 65; 64M pSRAM; 70;
pSRAM2; FTA084.
“Connection Diagram (S71PL127J)” on page 10
Updated pins D8, D9, and L5.
Added notes 2 and 3 to drawing.
“Connection Diagram (S71PL254J)” on page 11
Updated pins D8 and D9.
Added Note 2 to drawing.
“S71PL032J Valid Combinations” on page 14
Changed S71PL032J08 (p)SRAM Type Access Time (ns) from “SRAM1” to
“SRAM2” (4 changes made in table).
Changed S71PL032JA0 (p)SRAM Type Access Time (ns) from “SRAM3 / 70” to
pSRAM3 /70”.
Deleted all cells with the following collaborated text: “BAW,BFW, BAI. BFI”.
Merged previous place holder with cell above.
“S71PL064J Valid Combinations” on page 15
In (p)SRAM Type/Access Time (ns) changed all instances of “stet” to “pSRAM1/
70”.
In Package Modifier/Model Number changed all instances of “stet” to “07”.
Added row to BAW Package and Temperature sections with the following content:
S71PL064JB0; 07; 65 (previously inclusive); pSRAM1/70.
“S71PL127J Valid Combinations” on page 16
Changed the S71PL127JA0 Package Modifier/Model Number from “9Z” to “9P” (4
instances).
Added 4 rows with the following content: S71PL127JC0; 97; pSRAM1/70.
July 16, 2004 S71PL254/127/064/032J_00_A4 128
Advance Information
“S71PL254J Valid Combinations” on page 17
Added 4 rows with the following content: S71PL254JC0; TB; pSRAM2/70.
Added 4 rows with the following content: S71PL254JB0; TB; pSRAM2/70.
“S71PL254/127/064/032J based MCPs” on page 1
Added 254M to Megabit indicator.
Added 16 to CMOS indicator.
Colophon
The products described in this document are designed, developed and manufactured as contemplated for general use, including without limitation, ordinary
industrial use, general office use, personal use, and household use, but are not designed, developed and manufactured as contemplated (1) for any use that
includes fatal risks or dangers that, unless extremely high safety is secured, could have a serious effect to the public, and could lead directly to death, personal
injury, severe physical damage or other loss (i.e., nuclear reaction control in nuclear facility, aircraft flight control, air traffic control, mass transport control,
medical life support system, missile launch control in weapon system), or (2) for any use where chance of failure is intolerable (i.e., submersible repeater and
artificial satellite). Please note that Spansion will not be liable to you and/or any third party for any claims or damages arising in connection with above-men-
tioned uses of the products. Any semiconductor devices have an inherent chance of failure. You must protect against injury, damage or loss from such failures
by incorporating safety design measures into your facility and equipment such as redundancy, fire protection, and prevention of over-current levels and other
abnormal operating conditions. If any products described in this document represent goods or technologies subject to certain restrictions on export under
the Foreign Exchange and Foreign Trade Law of Japan, the US Export Administration Regulations or the applicable laws of any other country, the prior au-
thorization by the respective government entity will be required for export of those products.
Trademarks and Notice
The contents of this document are subject to change without notice. This document may contain information on a Spansion product under development by
Spansion LLC. Spansion LLC reserves the right to change or discontinue work on any product without notice. The information in this document is provided
as is without warranty or guarantee of any kind as to its accuracy, completeness, operability, fitness for particular purpose, merchantability, non-infringement
of third-party rights, or any other warranty, express, implied, or statutory. Spansion LLC assumes no liability for any damages of any kind arising out of the
use of the information in this document.
Copyright © 2003 Spansion LLC. All rights reserved. Spansion, the Spansion logo, MirrorBit, combinations thereof, and ExpressFlash are trademarks of Span-
sion LLC. Other company and product names used in this publication are for identification purposes only and may be trademarks of their respective compa-
nies.